* dwarf2read.c (struct attribute): Increase sizes of unsnd and snd
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / ada-lang.c
1 /* Ada language support routines for GDB, the GNU debugger. Copyright (C)
2
3 1992, 1993, 1994, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2007, 2008,
4 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5
6 This file is part of GDB.
7
8 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
11 (at your option) any later version.
12
13 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
17
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include <stdio.h>
24 #include "gdb_string.h"
25 #include <ctype.h>
26 #include <stdarg.h>
27 #include "demangle.h"
28 #include "gdb_regex.h"
29 #include "frame.h"
30 #include "symtab.h"
31 #include "gdbtypes.h"
32 #include "gdbcmd.h"
33 #include "expression.h"
34 #include "parser-defs.h"
35 #include "language.h"
36 #include "c-lang.h"
37 #include "inferior.h"
38 #include "symfile.h"
39 #include "objfiles.h"
40 #include "breakpoint.h"
41 #include "gdbcore.h"
42 #include "hashtab.h"
43 #include "gdb_obstack.h"
44 #include "ada-lang.h"
45 #include "completer.h"
46 #include "gdb_stat.h"
47 #ifdef UI_OUT
48 #include "ui-out.h"
49 #endif
50 #include "block.h"
51 #include "infcall.h"
52 #include "dictionary.h"
53 #include "exceptions.h"
54 #include "annotate.h"
55 #include "valprint.h"
56 #include "source.h"
57 #include "observer.h"
58 #include "vec.h"
59
60 /* Define whether or not the C operator '/' truncates towards zero for
61 differently signed operands (truncation direction is undefined in C).
62 Copied from valarith.c. */
63
64 #ifndef TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO
65 #define TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO ((-5 / 2) == -2)
66 #endif
67
68 static void extract_string (CORE_ADDR addr, char *buf);
69
70 static void modify_general_field (struct type *, char *, LONGEST, int, int);
71
72 static struct type *desc_base_type (struct type *);
73
74 static struct type *desc_bounds_type (struct type *);
75
76 static struct value *desc_bounds (struct value *);
77
78 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *);
79
80 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *);
81
82 static struct type *desc_data_target_type (struct type *);
83
84 static struct value *desc_data (struct value *);
85
86 static int fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *);
87
88 static int fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *);
89
90 static struct value *desc_one_bound (struct value *, int, int);
91
92 static int desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *, int, int);
93
94 static int desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *, int, int);
95
96 static struct type *desc_index_type (struct type *, int);
97
98 static int desc_arity (struct type *);
99
100 static int ada_type_match (struct type *, struct type *, int);
101
102 static int ada_args_match (struct symbol *, struct value **, int);
103
104 static struct value *ensure_lval (struct value *,
105 struct gdbarch *, CORE_ADDR *);
106
107 static struct value *make_array_descriptor (struct type *, struct value *,
108 struct gdbarch *, CORE_ADDR *);
109
110 static void ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *,
111 struct block *, const char *,
112 domain_enum, struct objfile *, int);
113
114 static int is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info *, int);
115
116 static void add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *, struct symbol *,
117 struct block *);
118
119 static int num_defns_collected (struct obstack *);
120
121 static struct ada_symbol_info *defns_collected (struct obstack *, int);
122
123 static struct partial_symbol *ada_lookup_partial_symbol (struct partial_symtab
124 *, const char *, int,
125 domain_enum, int);
126
127 static struct value *resolve_subexp (struct expression **, int *, int,
128 struct type *);
129
130 static void replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **, int, int, int,
131 struct symbol *, struct block *);
132
133 static int possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode, struct value **);
134
135 static char *ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
136
137 static const char *ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
138
139 static int numeric_type_p (struct type *);
140
141 static int integer_type_p (struct type *);
142
143 static int scalar_type_p (struct type *);
144
145 static int discrete_type_p (struct type *);
146
147 static enum ada_renaming_category parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *,
148 const char **,
149 int *,
150 const char **);
151
152 static struct symbol *find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *,
153 struct block *);
154
155 static struct type *ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *, char *,
156 int, int, int *);
157
158 static struct value *evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *, int *);
159
160 static int is_dynamic_field (struct type *, int);
161
162 static struct type *to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *,
163 const gdb_byte *,
164 CORE_ADDR, struct value *);
165
166 static struct type *to_fixed_array_type (struct type *, struct value *, int);
167
168 static struct type *to_fixed_range_type (char *, struct value *,
169 struct type *);
170
171 static struct type *to_static_fixed_type (struct type *);
172 static struct type *static_unwrap_type (struct type *type);
173
174 static struct value *unwrap_value (struct value *);
175
176 static struct type *constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *, long *);
177
178 static struct type *decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
179
180 static long decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *);
181
182 static struct value *decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *);
183
184 static int ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *);
185
186 static int ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
187
188 static struct value *value_subscript_packed (struct value *, int,
189 struct value **);
190
191 static void move_bits (gdb_byte *, int, const gdb_byte *, int, int, int);
192
193 static struct value *coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *,
194 struct type *);
195
196 static struct value *get_var_value (char *, char *);
197
198 static int lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *, struct symbol *);
199
200 static int equiv_types (struct type *, struct type *);
201
202 static int is_name_suffix (const char *);
203
204 static int wild_match (const char *, int, const char *);
205
206 static struct value *ada_coerce_ref (struct value *);
207
208 static LONGEST pos_atr (struct value *);
209
210 static struct value *value_pos_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
211
212 static struct value *value_val_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
213
214 static struct symbol *standard_lookup (const char *, const struct block *,
215 domain_enum);
216
217 static struct value *ada_search_struct_field (char *, struct value *, int,
218 struct type *);
219
220 static struct value *ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *, int, int,
221 struct type *);
222
223 static int find_struct_field (char *, struct type *, int,
224 struct type **, int *, int *, int *, int *);
225
226 static struct value *ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *, CORE_ADDR,
227 struct value *);
228
229 static struct value *ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *);
230
231 static int ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info *, int,
232 struct value **, int, const char *,
233 struct type *);
234
235 static struct value *ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *);
236
237 static int ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *);
238
239 static void ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *,
240 struct language_arch_info *);
241
242 static void check_size (const struct type *);
243
244 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field (int, struct value *, int,
245 struct type *);
246
247 static struct value *assign_aggregate (struct value *, struct value *,
248 struct expression *, int *, enum noside);
249
250 static void aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *, struct value *,
251 struct expression *,
252 int *, LONGEST *, int *,
253 int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
254
255 static void aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *, struct value *,
256 struct expression *,
257 int *, LONGEST *, int *, int,
258 LONGEST, LONGEST);
259
260
261 static void aggregate_assign_others (struct value *, struct value *,
262 struct expression *,
263 int *, LONGEST *, int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
264
265
266 static void add_component_interval (LONGEST, LONGEST, LONGEST *, int *, int);
267
268
269 static struct value *ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *, struct expression *,
270 int *, enum noside);
271
272 static void ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *, int, int *,
273 int *);
274 \f
275
276
277 /* Maximum-sized dynamic type. */
278 static unsigned int varsize_limit;
279
280 /* FIXME: brobecker/2003-09-17: No longer a const because it is
281 returned by a function that does not return a const char *. */
282 static char *ada_completer_word_break_characters =
283 #ifdef VMS
284 " \t\n!@#%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
285 #else
286 " \t\n!@#$%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
287 #endif
288
289 /* The name of the symbol to use to get the name of the main subprogram. */
290 static const char ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME[]
291 = "__gnat_ada_main_program_name";
292
293 /* Limit on the number of warnings to raise per expression evaluation. */
294 static int warning_limit = 2;
295
296 /* Number of warning messages issued; reset to 0 by cleanups after
297 expression evaluation. */
298 static int warnings_issued = 0;
299
300 static const char *known_runtime_file_name_patterns[] = {
301 ADA_KNOWN_RUNTIME_FILE_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
302 };
303
304 static const char *known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[] = {
305 ADA_KNOWN_AUXILIARY_FUNCTION_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
306 };
307
308 /* Space for allocating results of ada_lookup_symbol_list. */
309 static struct obstack symbol_list_obstack;
310
311 /* Utilities */
312
313 /* Given DECODED_NAME a string holding a symbol name in its
314 decoded form (ie using the Ada dotted notation), returns
315 its unqualified name. */
316
317 static const char *
318 ada_unqualified_name (const char *decoded_name)
319 {
320 const char *result = strrchr (decoded_name, '.');
321
322 if (result != NULL)
323 result++; /* Skip the dot... */
324 else
325 result = decoded_name;
326
327 return result;
328 }
329
330 /* Return a string starting with '<', followed by STR, and '>'.
331 The result is good until the next call. */
332
333 static char *
334 add_angle_brackets (const char *str)
335 {
336 static char *result = NULL;
337
338 xfree (result);
339 result = xstrprintf ("<%s>", str);
340 return result;
341 }
342
343 static char *
344 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters (void)
345 {
346 return ada_completer_word_break_characters;
347 }
348
349 /* Print an array element index using the Ada syntax. */
350
351 static void
352 ada_print_array_index (struct value *index_value, struct ui_file *stream,
353 const struct value_print_options *options)
354 {
355 LA_VALUE_PRINT (index_value, stream, options);
356 fprintf_filtered (stream, " => ");
357 }
358
359 /* Read the string located at ADDR from the inferior and store the
360 result into BUF. */
361
362 static void
363 extract_string (CORE_ADDR addr, char *buf)
364 {
365 int char_index = 0;
366
367 /* Loop, reading one byte at a time, until we reach the '\000'
368 end-of-string marker. */
369 do
370 {
371 target_read_memory (addr + char_index * sizeof (char),
372 buf + char_index * sizeof (char), sizeof (char));
373 char_index++;
374 }
375 while (buf[char_index - 1] != '\000');
376 }
377
378 /* Assuming VECT points to an array of *SIZE objects of size
379 ELEMENT_SIZE, grow it to contain at least MIN_SIZE objects,
380 updating *SIZE as necessary and returning the (new) array. */
381
382 void *
383 grow_vect (void *vect, size_t *size, size_t min_size, int element_size)
384 {
385 if (*size < min_size)
386 {
387 *size *= 2;
388 if (*size < min_size)
389 *size = min_size;
390 vect = xrealloc (vect, *size * element_size);
391 }
392 return vect;
393 }
394
395 /* True (non-zero) iff TARGET matches FIELD_NAME up to any trailing
396 suffix of FIELD_NAME beginning "___". */
397
398 static int
399 field_name_match (const char *field_name, const char *target)
400 {
401 int len = strlen (target);
402 return
403 (strncmp (field_name, target, len) == 0
404 && (field_name[len] == '\0'
405 || (strncmp (field_name + len, "___", 3) == 0
406 && strcmp (field_name + strlen (field_name) - 6,
407 "___XVN") != 0)));
408 }
409
410
411 /* Assuming TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT or a TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF to
412 a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT, find the field whose name matches FIELD_NAME,
413 and return its index. This function also handles fields whose name
414 have ___ suffixes because the compiler sometimes alters their name
415 by adding such a suffix to represent fields with certain constraints.
416 If the field could not be found, return a negative number if
417 MAYBE_MISSING is set. Otherwise raise an error. */
418
419 int
420 ada_get_field_index (const struct type *type, const char *field_name,
421 int maybe_missing)
422 {
423 int fieldno;
424 struct type *struct_type = check_typedef ((struct type *) type);
425
426 for (fieldno = 0; fieldno < TYPE_NFIELDS (struct_type); fieldno++)
427 if (field_name_match (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (struct_type, fieldno), field_name))
428 return fieldno;
429
430 if (!maybe_missing)
431 error (_("Unable to find field %s in struct %s. Aborting"),
432 field_name, TYPE_NAME (struct_type));
433
434 return -1;
435 }
436
437 /* The length of the prefix of NAME prior to any "___" suffix. */
438
439 int
440 ada_name_prefix_len (const char *name)
441 {
442 if (name == NULL)
443 return 0;
444 else
445 {
446 const char *p = strstr (name, "___");
447 if (p == NULL)
448 return strlen (name);
449 else
450 return p - name;
451 }
452 }
453
454 /* Return non-zero if SUFFIX is a suffix of STR.
455 Return zero if STR is null. */
456
457 static int
458 is_suffix (const char *str, const char *suffix)
459 {
460 int len1, len2;
461 if (str == NULL)
462 return 0;
463 len1 = strlen (str);
464 len2 = strlen (suffix);
465 return (len1 >= len2 && strcmp (str + len1 - len2, suffix) == 0);
466 }
467
468 /* The contents of value VAL, treated as a value of type TYPE. The
469 result is an lval in memory if VAL is. */
470
471 static struct value *
472 coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *val, struct type *type)
473 {
474 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
475 if (value_type (val) == type)
476 return val;
477 else
478 {
479 struct value *result;
480
481 /* Make sure that the object size is not unreasonable before
482 trying to allocate some memory for it. */
483 check_size (type);
484
485 result = allocate_value (type);
486 set_value_component_location (result, val);
487 set_value_bitsize (result, value_bitsize (val));
488 set_value_bitpos (result, value_bitpos (val));
489 set_value_address (result, value_address (val));
490 if (value_lazy (val)
491 || TYPE_LENGTH (type) > TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)))
492 set_value_lazy (result, 1);
493 else
494 memcpy (value_contents_raw (result), value_contents (val),
495 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
496 return result;
497 }
498 }
499
500 static const gdb_byte *
501 cond_offset_host (const gdb_byte *valaddr, long offset)
502 {
503 if (valaddr == NULL)
504 return NULL;
505 else
506 return valaddr + offset;
507 }
508
509 static CORE_ADDR
510 cond_offset_target (CORE_ADDR address, long offset)
511 {
512 if (address == 0)
513 return 0;
514 else
515 return address + offset;
516 }
517
518 /* Issue a warning (as for the definition of warning in utils.c, but
519 with exactly one argument rather than ...), unless the limit on the
520 number of warnings has passed during the evaluation of the current
521 expression. */
522
523 /* FIXME: cagney/2004-10-10: This function is mimicking the behavior
524 provided by "complaint". */
525 static void lim_warning (const char *format, ...) ATTR_FORMAT (printf, 1, 2);
526
527 static void
528 lim_warning (const char *format, ...)
529 {
530 va_list args;
531 va_start (args, format);
532
533 warnings_issued += 1;
534 if (warnings_issued <= warning_limit)
535 vwarning (format, args);
536
537 va_end (args);
538 }
539
540 /* Issue an error if the size of an object of type T is unreasonable,
541 i.e. if it would be a bad idea to allocate a value of this type in
542 GDB. */
543
544 static void
545 check_size (const struct type *type)
546 {
547 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) > varsize_limit)
548 error (_("object size is larger than varsize-limit"));
549 }
550
551
552 /* Note: would have used MAX_OF_TYPE and MIN_OF_TYPE macros from
553 gdbtypes.h, but some of the necessary definitions in that file
554 seem to have gone missing. */
555
556 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
557 static LONGEST
558 max_of_size (int size)
559 {
560 LONGEST top_bit = (LONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 2);
561 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
562 }
563
564 /* Minimum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
565 static LONGEST
566 min_of_size (int size)
567 {
568 return -max_of_size (size) - 1;
569 }
570
571 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte unsigned integer type. */
572 static ULONGEST
573 umax_of_size (int size)
574 {
575 ULONGEST top_bit = (ULONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 1);
576 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
577 }
578
579 /* Maximum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
580 static LONGEST
581 max_of_type (struct type *t)
582 {
583 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
584 return (LONGEST) umax_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
585 else
586 return max_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
587 }
588
589 /* Minimum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
590 static LONGEST
591 min_of_type (struct type *t)
592 {
593 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
594 return 0;
595 else
596 return min_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
597 }
598
599 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
600 LONGEST
601 ada_discrete_type_high_bound (struct type *type)
602 {
603 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
604 {
605 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
606 return TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type);
607 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
608 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, TYPE_NFIELDS (type) - 1);
609 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
610 return 1;
611 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
612 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
613 return max_of_type (type);
614 default:
615 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_high_bound."));
616 }
617 }
618
619 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
620 LONGEST
621 ada_discrete_type_low_bound (struct type *type)
622 {
623 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
624 {
625 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
626 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type);
627 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
628 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, 0);
629 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
630 return 0;
631 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
632 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
633 return min_of_type (type);
634 default:
635 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_low_bound."));
636 }
637 }
638
639 /* The identity on non-range types. For range types, the underlying
640 non-range scalar type. */
641
642 static struct type *
643 base_type (struct type *type)
644 {
645 while (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
646 {
647 if (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) || TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == NULL)
648 return type;
649 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
650 }
651 return type;
652 }
653 \f
654
655 /* Language Selection */
656
657 /* If the main program is in Ada, return language_ada, otherwise return LANG
658 (the main program is in Ada iif the adainit symbol is found).
659
660 MAIN_PST is not used. */
661
662 enum language
663 ada_update_initial_language (enum language lang,
664 struct partial_symtab *main_pst)
665 {
666 if (lookup_minimal_symbol ("adainit", (const char *) NULL,
667 (struct objfile *) NULL) != NULL)
668 return language_ada;
669
670 return lang;
671 }
672
673 /* If the main procedure is written in Ada, then return its name.
674 The result is good until the next call. Return NULL if the main
675 procedure doesn't appear to be in Ada. */
676
677 char *
678 ada_main_name (void)
679 {
680 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
681 static char *main_program_name = NULL;
682
683 /* For Ada, the name of the main procedure is stored in a specific
684 string constant, generated by the binder. Look for that symbol,
685 extract its address, and then read that string. If we didn't find
686 that string, then most probably the main procedure is not written
687 in Ada. */
688 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol (ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME, NULL, NULL);
689
690 if (msym != NULL)
691 {
692 CORE_ADDR main_program_name_addr;
693 int err_code;
694
695 main_program_name_addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msym);
696 if (main_program_name_addr == 0)
697 error (_("Invalid address for Ada main program name."));
698
699 xfree (main_program_name);
700 target_read_string (main_program_name_addr, &main_program_name,
701 1024, &err_code);
702
703 if (err_code != 0)
704 return NULL;
705 return main_program_name;
706 }
707
708 /* The main procedure doesn't seem to be in Ada. */
709 return NULL;
710 }
711 \f
712 /* Symbols */
713
714 /* Table of Ada operators and their GNAT-encoded names. Last entry is pair
715 of NULLs. */
716
717 const struct ada_opname_map ada_opname_table[] = {
718 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", BINOP_ADD},
719 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", BINOP_SUB},
720 {"Omultiply", "\"*\"", BINOP_MUL},
721 {"Odivide", "\"/\"", BINOP_DIV},
722 {"Omod", "\"mod\"", BINOP_MOD},
723 {"Orem", "\"rem\"", BINOP_REM},
724 {"Oexpon", "\"**\"", BINOP_EXP},
725 {"Olt", "\"<\"", BINOP_LESS},
726 {"Ole", "\"<=\"", BINOP_LEQ},
727 {"Ogt", "\">\"", BINOP_GTR},
728 {"Oge", "\">=\"", BINOP_GEQ},
729 {"Oeq", "\"=\"", BINOP_EQUAL},
730 {"One", "\"/=\"", BINOP_NOTEQUAL},
731 {"Oand", "\"and\"", BINOP_BITWISE_AND},
732 {"Oor", "\"or\"", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR},
733 {"Oxor", "\"xor\"", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR},
734 {"Oconcat", "\"&\"", BINOP_CONCAT},
735 {"Oabs", "\"abs\"", UNOP_ABS},
736 {"Onot", "\"not\"", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT},
737 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", UNOP_PLUS},
738 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", UNOP_NEG},
739 {NULL, NULL}
740 };
741
742 /* The "encoded" form of DECODED, according to GNAT conventions.
743 The result is valid until the next call to ada_encode. */
744
745 char *
746 ada_encode (const char *decoded)
747 {
748 static char *encoding_buffer = NULL;
749 static size_t encoding_buffer_size = 0;
750 const char *p;
751 int k;
752
753 if (decoded == NULL)
754 return NULL;
755
756 GROW_VECT (encoding_buffer, encoding_buffer_size,
757 2 * strlen (decoded) + 10);
758
759 k = 0;
760 for (p = decoded; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
761 {
762 if (*p == '.')
763 {
764 encoding_buffer[k] = encoding_buffer[k + 1] = '_';
765 k += 2;
766 }
767 else if (*p == '"')
768 {
769 const struct ada_opname_map *mapping;
770
771 for (mapping = ada_opname_table;
772 mapping->encoded != NULL
773 && strncmp (mapping->decoded, p,
774 strlen (mapping->decoded)) != 0; mapping += 1)
775 ;
776 if (mapping->encoded == NULL)
777 error (_("invalid Ada operator name: %s"), p);
778 strcpy (encoding_buffer + k, mapping->encoded);
779 k += strlen (mapping->encoded);
780 break;
781 }
782 else
783 {
784 encoding_buffer[k] = *p;
785 k += 1;
786 }
787 }
788
789 encoding_buffer[k] = '\0';
790 return encoding_buffer;
791 }
792
793 /* Return NAME folded to lower case, or, if surrounded by single
794 quotes, unfolded, but with the quotes stripped away. Result good
795 to next call. */
796
797 char *
798 ada_fold_name (const char *name)
799 {
800 static char *fold_buffer = NULL;
801 static size_t fold_buffer_size = 0;
802
803 int len = strlen (name);
804 GROW_VECT (fold_buffer, fold_buffer_size, len + 1);
805
806 if (name[0] == '\'')
807 {
808 strncpy (fold_buffer, name + 1, len - 2);
809 fold_buffer[len - 2] = '\000';
810 }
811 else
812 {
813 int i;
814 for (i = 0; i <= len; i += 1)
815 fold_buffer[i] = tolower (name[i]);
816 }
817
818 return fold_buffer;
819 }
820
821 /* Return nonzero if C is either a digit or a lowercase alphabet character. */
822
823 static int
824 is_lower_alphanum (const char c)
825 {
826 return (isdigit (c) || (isalpha (c) && islower (c)));
827 }
828
829 /* Remove either of these suffixes:
830 . .{DIGIT}+
831 . ${DIGIT}+
832 . ___{DIGIT}+
833 . __{DIGIT}+.
834 These are suffixes introduced by the compiler for entities such as
835 nested subprogram for instance, in order to avoid name clashes.
836 They do not serve any purpose for the debugger. */
837
838 static void
839 ada_remove_trailing_digits (const char *encoded, int *len)
840 {
841 if (*len > 1 && isdigit (encoded[*len - 1]))
842 {
843 int i = *len - 2;
844 while (i > 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
845 i--;
846 if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '.')
847 *len = i;
848 else if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '$')
849 *len = i;
850 else if (i >= 2 && strncmp (encoded + i - 2, "___", 3) == 0)
851 *len = i - 2;
852 else if (i >= 1 && strncmp (encoded + i - 1, "__", 2) == 0)
853 *len = i - 1;
854 }
855 }
856
857 /* Remove the suffix introduced by the compiler for protected object
858 subprograms. */
859
860 static void
861 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
862 {
863 /* Remove trailing N. */
864
865 /* Protected entry subprograms are broken into two
866 separate subprograms: The first one is unprotected, and has
867 a 'N' suffix; the second is the protected version, and has
868 the 'P' suffix. The second calls the first one after handling
869 the protection. Since the P subprograms are internally generated,
870 we leave these names undecoded, giving the user a clue that this
871 entity is internal. */
872
873 if (*len > 1
874 && encoded[*len - 1] == 'N'
875 && (isdigit (encoded[*len - 2]) || islower (encoded[*len - 2])))
876 *len = *len - 1;
877 }
878
879 /* Remove trailing X[bn]* suffixes (indicating names in package bodies). */
880
881 static void
882 ada_remove_Xbn_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
883 {
884 int i = *len - 1;
885
886 while (i > 0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'))
887 i--;
888
889 if (encoded[i] != 'X')
890 return;
891
892 if (i == 0)
893 return;
894
895 if (isalnum (encoded[i-1]))
896 *len = i;
897 }
898
899 /* If ENCODED follows the GNAT entity encoding conventions, then return
900 the decoded form of ENCODED. Otherwise, return "<%s>" where "%s" is
901 replaced by ENCODED.
902
903 The resulting string is valid until the next call of ada_decode.
904 If the string is unchanged by decoding, the original string pointer
905 is returned. */
906
907 const char *
908 ada_decode (const char *encoded)
909 {
910 int i, j;
911 int len0;
912 const char *p;
913 char *decoded;
914 int at_start_name;
915 static char *decoding_buffer = NULL;
916 static size_t decoding_buffer_size = 0;
917
918 /* The name of the Ada main procedure starts with "_ada_".
919 This prefix is not part of the decoded name, so skip this part
920 if we see this prefix. */
921 if (strncmp (encoded, "_ada_", 5) == 0)
922 encoded += 5;
923
924 /* If the name starts with '_', then it is not a properly encoded
925 name, so do not attempt to decode it. Similarly, if the name
926 starts with '<', the name should not be decoded. */
927 if (encoded[0] == '_' || encoded[0] == '<')
928 goto Suppress;
929
930 len0 = strlen (encoded);
931
932 ada_remove_trailing_digits (encoded, &len0);
933 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (encoded, &len0);
934
935 /* Remove the ___X.* suffix if present. Do not forget to verify that
936 the suffix is located before the current "end" of ENCODED. We want
937 to avoid re-matching parts of ENCODED that have previously been
938 marked as discarded (by decrementing LEN0). */
939 p = strstr (encoded, "___");
940 if (p != NULL && p - encoded < len0 - 3)
941 {
942 if (p[3] == 'X')
943 len0 = p - encoded;
944 else
945 goto Suppress;
946 }
947
948 /* Remove any trailing TKB suffix. It tells us that this symbol
949 is for the body of a task, but that information does not actually
950 appear in the decoded name. */
951
952 if (len0 > 3 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 3, "TKB", 3) == 0)
953 len0 -= 3;
954
955 /* Remove any trailing TB suffix. The TB suffix is slightly different
956 from the TKB suffix because it is used for non-anonymous task
957 bodies. */
958
959 if (len0 > 2 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 2, "TB", 2) == 0)
960 len0 -= 2;
961
962 /* Remove trailing "B" suffixes. */
963 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-04-19: Not sure what this are used for... */
964
965 if (len0 > 1 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 1, "B", 1) == 0)
966 len0 -= 1;
967
968 /* Make decoded big enough for possible expansion by operator name. */
969
970 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, 2 * len0 + 1);
971 decoded = decoding_buffer;
972
973 /* Remove trailing __{digit}+ or trailing ${digit}+. */
974
975 if (len0 > 1 && isdigit (encoded[len0 - 1]))
976 {
977 i = len0 - 2;
978 while ((i >= 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
979 || (i >= 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && isdigit (encoded[i - 1])))
980 i -= 1;
981 if (i > 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i - 1] == '_')
982 len0 = i - 1;
983 else if (encoded[i] == '$')
984 len0 = i;
985 }
986
987 /* The first few characters that are not alphabetic are not part
988 of any encoding we use, so we can copy them over verbatim. */
989
990 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < len0 && !isalpha (encoded[i]); i += 1, j += 1)
991 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
992
993 at_start_name = 1;
994 while (i < len0)
995 {
996 /* Is this a symbol function? */
997 if (at_start_name && encoded[i] == 'O')
998 {
999 int k;
1000 for (k = 0; ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL; k += 1)
1001 {
1002 int op_len = strlen (ada_opname_table[k].encoded);
1003 if ((strncmp (ada_opname_table[k].encoded + 1, encoded + i + 1,
1004 op_len - 1) == 0)
1005 && !isalnum (encoded[i + op_len]))
1006 {
1007 strcpy (decoded + j, ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1008 at_start_name = 0;
1009 i += op_len;
1010 j += strlen (ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1011 break;
1012 }
1013 }
1014 if (ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL)
1015 continue;
1016 }
1017 at_start_name = 0;
1018
1019 /* Replace "TK__" with "__", which will eventually be translated
1020 into "." (just below). */
1021
1022 if (i < len0 - 4 && strncmp (encoded + i, "TK__", 4) == 0)
1023 i += 2;
1024
1025 /* Replace "__B_{DIGITS}+__" sequences by "__", which will eventually
1026 be translated into "." (just below). These are internal names
1027 generated for anonymous blocks inside which our symbol is nested. */
1028
1029 if (len0 - i > 5 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded [i+1] == '_'
1030 && encoded [i+2] == 'B' && encoded [i+3] == '_'
1031 && isdigit (encoded [i+4]))
1032 {
1033 int k = i + 5;
1034
1035 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1036 k++; /* Skip any extra digit. */
1037
1038 /* Double-check that the "__B_{DIGITS}+" sequence we found
1039 is indeed followed by "__". */
1040 if (len0 - k > 2 && encoded [k] == '_' && encoded [k+1] == '_')
1041 i = k;
1042 }
1043
1044 /* Remove _E{DIGITS}+[sb] */
1045
1046 /* Just as for protected object subprograms, there are 2 categories
1047 of subprograms created by the compiler for each entry. The first
1048 one implements the actual entry code, and has a suffix following
1049 the convention above; the second one implements the barrier and
1050 uses the same convention as above, except that the 'E' is replaced
1051 by a 'B'.
1052
1053 Just as above, we do not decode the name of barrier functions
1054 to give the user a clue that the code he is debugging has been
1055 internally generated. */
1056
1057 if (len0 - i > 3 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded[i+1] == 'E'
1058 && isdigit (encoded[i+2]))
1059 {
1060 int k = i + 3;
1061
1062 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1063 k++;
1064
1065 if (k < len0
1066 && (encoded[k] == 'b' || encoded[k] == 's'))
1067 {
1068 k++;
1069 /* Just as an extra precaution, make sure that if this
1070 suffix is followed by anything else, it is a '_'.
1071 Otherwise, we matched this sequence by accident. */
1072 if (k == len0
1073 || (k < len0 && encoded[k] == '_'))
1074 i = k;
1075 }
1076 }
1077
1078 /* Remove trailing "N" in [a-z0-9]+N__. The N is added by
1079 the GNAT front-end in protected object subprograms. */
1080
1081 if (i < len0 + 3
1082 && encoded[i] == 'N' && encoded[i+1] == '_' && encoded[i+2] == '_')
1083 {
1084 /* Backtrack a bit up until we reach either the begining of
1085 the encoded name, or "__". Make sure that we only find
1086 digits or lowercase characters. */
1087 const char *ptr = encoded + i - 1;
1088
1089 while (ptr >= encoded && is_lower_alphanum (ptr[0]))
1090 ptr--;
1091 if (ptr < encoded
1092 || (ptr > encoded && ptr[0] == '_' && ptr[-1] == '_'))
1093 i++;
1094 }
1095
1096 if (encoded[i] == 'X' && i != 0 && isalnum (encoded[i - 1]))
1097 {
1098 /* This is a X[bn]* sequence not separated from the previous
1099 part of the name with a non-alpha-numeric character (in other
1100 words, immediately following an alpha-numeric character), then
1101 verify that it is placed at the end of the encoded name. If
1102 not, then the encoding is not valid and we should abort the
1103 decoding. Otherwise, just skip it, it is used in body-nested
1104 package names. */
1105 do
1106 i += 1;
1107 while (i < len0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'));
1108 if (i < len0)
1109 goto Suppress;
1110 }
1111 else if (i < len0 - 2 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i + 1] == '_')
1112 {
1113 /* Replace '__' by '.'. */
1114 decoded[j] = '.';
1115 at_start_name = 1;
1116 i += 2;
1117 j += 1;
1118 }
1119 else
1120 {
1121 /* It's a character part of the decoded name, so just copy it
1122 over. */
1123 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1124 i += 1;
1125 j += 1;
1126 }
1127 }
1128 decoded[j] = '\000';
1129
1130 /* Decoded names should never contain any uppercase character.
1131 Double-check this, and abort the decoding if we find one. */
1132
1133 for (i = 0; decoded[i] != '\0'; i += 1)
1134 if (isupper (decoded[i]) || decoded[i] == ' ')
1135 goto Suppress;
1136
1137 if (strcmp (decoded, encoded) == 0)
1138 return encoded;
1139 else
1140 return decoded;
1141
1142 Suppress:
1143 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, strlen (encoded) + 3);
1144 decoded = decoding_buffer;
1145 if (encoded[0] == '<')
1146 strcpy (decoded, encoded);
1147 else
1148 xsnprintf (decoded, decoding_buffer_size, "<%s>", encoded);
1149 return decoded;
1150
1151 }
1152
1153 /* Table for keeping permanent unique copies of decoded names. Once
1154 allocated, names in this table are never released. While this is a
1155 storage leak, it should not be significant unless there are massive
1156 changes in the set of decoded names in successive versions of a
1157 symbol table loaded during a single session. */
1158 static struct htab *decoded_names_store;
1159
1160 /* Returns the decoded name of GSYMBOL, as for ada_decode, caching it
1161 in the language-specific part of GSYMBOL, if it has not been
1162 previously computed. Tries to save the decoded name in the same
1163 obstack as GSYMBOL, if possible, and otherwise on the heap (so that,
1164 in any case, the decoded symbol has a lifetime at least that of
1165 GSYMBOL).
1166 The GSYMBOL parameter is "mutable" in the C++ sense: logically
1167 const, but nevertheless modified to a semantically equivalent form
1168 when a decoded name is cached in it.
1169 */
1170
1171 char *
1172 ada_decode_symbol (const struct general_symbol_info *gsymbol)
1173 {
1174 char **resultp =
1175 (char **) &gsymbol->language_specific.cplus_specific.demangled_name;
1176 if (*resultp == NULL)
1177 {
1178 const char *decoded = ada_decode (gsymbol->name);
1179 if (gsymbol->obj_section != NULL)
1180 {
1181 struct objfile *objf = gsymbol->obj_section->objfile;
1182 *resultp = obsavestring (decoded, strlen (decoded),
1183 &objf->objfile_obstack);
1184 }
1185 /* Sometimes, we can't find a corresponding objfile, in which
1186 case, we put the result on the heap. Since we only decode
1187 when needed, we hope this usually does not cause a
1188 significant memory leak (FIXME). */
1189 if (*resultp == NULL)
1190 {
1191 char **slot = (char **) htab_find_slot (decoded_names_store,
1192 decoded, INSERT);
1193 if (*slot == NULL)
1194 *slot = xstrdup (decoded);
1195 *resultp = *slot;
1196 }
1197 }
1198
1199 return *resultp;
1200 }
1201
1202 static char *
1203 ada_la_decode (const char *encoded, int options)
1204 {
1205 return xstrdup (ada_decode (encoded));
1206 }
1207
1208 /* Returns non-zero iff SYM_NAME matches NAME, ignoring any trailing
1209 suffixes that encode debugging information or leading _ada_ on
1210 SYM_NAME (see is_name_suffix commentary for the debugging
1211 information that is ignored). If WILD, then NAME need only match a
1212 suffix of SYM_NAME minus the same suffixes. Also returns 0 if
1213 either argument is NULL. */
1214
1215 static int
1216 ada_match_name (const char *sym_name, const char *name, int wild)
1217 {
1218 if (sym_name == NULL || name == NULL)
1219 return 0;
1220 else if (wild)
1221 return wild_match (name, strlen (name), sym_name);
1222 else
1223 {
1224 int len_name = strlen (name);
1225 return (strncmp (sym_name, name, len_name) == 0
1226 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name))
1227 || (strncmp (sym_name, "_ada_", 5) == 0
1228 && strncmp (sym_name + 5, name, len_name) == 0
1229 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name + 5));
1230 }
1231 }
1232 \f
1233
1234 /* Arrays */
1235
1236 /* Names of MAX_ADA_DIMENS bounds in P_BOUNDS fields of array descriptors. */
1237
1238 static char *bound_name[] = {
1239 "LB0", "UB0", "LB1", "UB1", "LB2", "UB2", "LB3", "UB3",
1240 "LB4", "UB4", "LB5", "UB5", "LB6", "UB6", "LB7", "UB7"
1241 };
1242
1243 /* Maximum number of array dimensions we are prepared to handle. */
1244
1245 #define MAX_ADA_DIMENS (sizeof(bound_name) / (2*sizeof(char *)))
1246
1247 /* Like modify_field, but allows bitpos > wordlength. */
1248
1249 static void
1250 modify_general_field (struct type *type, char *addr,
1251 LONGEST fieldval, int bitpos, int bitsize)
1252 {
1253 modify_field (type, addr + bitpos / 8, fieldval, bitpos % 8, bitsize);
1254 }
1255
1256
1257 /* The desc_* routines return primitive portions of array descriptors
1258 (fat pointers). */
1259
1260 /* The descriptor or array type, if any, indicated by TYPE; removes
1261 level of indirection, if needed. */
1262
1263 static struct type *
1264 desc_base_type (struct type *type)
1265 {
1266 if (type == NULL)
1267 return NULL;
1268 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1269 if (type != NULL
1270 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1271 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1272 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
1273 else
1274 return type;
1275 }
1276
1277 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thin" array pointer type. */
1278
1279 static int
1280 is_thin_pntr (struct type *type)
1281 {
1282 return
1283 is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT")
1284 || is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT___XVE");
1285 }
1286
1287 /* The descriptor type for thin pointer type TYPE. */
1288
1289 static struct type *
1290 thin_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1291 {
1292 struct type *base_type = desc_base_type (type);
1293 if (base_type == NULL)
1294 return NULL;
1295 if (is_suffix (ada_type_name (base_type), "___XVE"))
1296 return base_type;
1297 else
1298 {
1299 struct type *alt_type = ada_find_parallel_type (base_type, "___XVE");
1300 if (alt_type == NULL)
1301 return base_type;
1302 else
1303 return alt_type;
1304 }
1305 }
1306
1307 /* A pointer to the array data for thin-pointer value VAL. */
1308
1309 static struct value *
1310 thin_data_pntr (struct value *val)
1311 {
1312 struct type *type = value_type (val);
1313 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1314 data_type = lookup_pointer_type (data_type);
1315
1316 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1317 return value_cast (data_type, value_copy (val));
1318 else
1319 return value_from_longest (data_type, value_address (val));
1320 }
1321
1322 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thick" array pointer type. */
1323
1324 static int
1325 is_thick_pntr (struct type *type)
1326 {
1327 type = desc_base_type (type);
1328 return (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1329 && lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL);
1330 }
1331
1332 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1333 pointer to one, the type of its bounds data; otherwise, NULL. */
1334
1335 static struct type *
1336 desc_bounds_type (struct type *type)
1337 {
1338 struct type *r;
1339
1340 type = desc_base_type (type);
1341
1342 if (type == NULL)
1343 return NULL;
1344 else if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1345 {
1346 type = thin_descriptor_type (type);
1347 if (type == NULL)
1348 return NULL;
1349 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "BOUNDS", 1);
1350 if (r != NULL)
1351 return ada_check_typedef (r);
1352 }
1353 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1354 {
1355 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1);
1356 if (r != NULL)
1357 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (r)));
1358 }
1359 return NULL;
1360 }
1361
1362 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), or pointer to
1363 one, a pointer to its bounds data. Otherwise NULL. */
1364
1365 static struct value *
1366 desc_bounds (struct value *arr)
1367 {
1368 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1369 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1370 {
1371 struct type *bounds_type =
1372 desc_bounds_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1373 LONGEST addr;
1374
1375 if (bounds_type == NULL)
1376 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1377
1378 /* NOTE: The following calculation is not really kosher, but
1379 since desc_type is an XVE-encoded type (and shouldn't be),
1380 the correct calculation is a real pain. FIXME (and fix GCC). */
1381 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1382 addr = value_as_long (arr);
1383 else
1384 addr = value_address (arr);
1385
1386 return
1387 value_from_longest (lookup_pointer_type (bounds_type),
1388 addr - TYPE_LENGTH (bounds_type));
1389 }
1390
1391 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1392 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_BOUNDS", NULL,
1393 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1394 else
1395 return NULL;
1396 }
1397
1398 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1399 position of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1400
1401 static int
1402 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *type)
1403 {
1404 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 1);
1405 }
1406
1407 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1408 size of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1409
1410 static int
1411 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *type)
1412 {
1413 type = desc_base_type (type);
1414
1415 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1) > 0)
1416 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1);
1417 else
1418 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 1)));
1419 }
1420
1421 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1422 pointer to one, the type of its array data (a array-with-no-bounds type);
1423 otherwise, NULL. Use ada_type_of_array to get an array type with bounds
1424 data. */
1425
1426 static struct type *
1427 desc_data_target_type (struct type *type)
1428 {
1429 type = desc_base_type (type);
1430
1431 /* NOTE: The following is bogus; see comment in desc_bounds. */
1432 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1433 return desc_base_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (thin_descriptor_type (type), 1));
1434 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1435 {
1436 struct type *data_type = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1);
1437
1438 if (data_type
1439 && TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (data_type)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1440 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (data_type);
1441 }
1442
1443 return NULL;
1444 }
1445
1446 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), a pointer to
1447 its array data. */
1448
1449 static struct value *
1450 desc_data (struct value *arr)
1451 {
1452 struct type *type = value_type (arr);
1453 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1454 return thin_data_pntr (arr);
1455 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1456 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_ARRAY", NULL,
1457 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1458 else
1459 return NULL;
1460 }
1461
1462
1463 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1464 position of the field containing the address of the data. */
1465
1466 static int
1467 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *type)
1468 {
1469 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 0);
1470 }
1471
1472 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1473 size of the field containing the address of the data. */
1474
1475 static int
1476 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *type)
1477 {
1478 type = desc_base_type (type);
1479
1480 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0)
1481 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0);
1482 else
1483 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
1484 }
1485
1486 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure (or pointer to one), return
1487 the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1488 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1489
1490 static struct value *
1491 desc_one_bound (struct value *bounds, int i, int which)
1492 {
1493 return value_struct_elt (&bounds, NULL, bound_name[2 * i + which - 2], NULL,
1494 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor bounds"));
1495 }
1496
1497 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit position
1498 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1499 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1500
1501 static int
1502 desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1503 {
1504 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 2 * i + which - 2);
1505 }
1506
1507 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit field size
1508 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1509 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1510
1511 static int
1512 desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1513 {
1514 type = desc_base_type (type);
1515
1516 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2) > 0)
1517 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2);
1518 else
1519 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 2 * i + which - 2));
1520 }
1521
1522 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-bounds structure, the type of its
1523 Ith bound (numbering from 1). Otherwise, NULL. */
1524
1525 static struct type *
1526 desc_index_type (struct type *type, int i)
1527 {
1528 type = desc_base_type (type);
1529
1530 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1531 return lookup_struct_elt_type (type, bound_name[2 * i - 2], 1);
1532 else
1533 return NULL;
1534 }
1535
1536 /* The number of index positions in the array-bounds type TYPE.
1537 Return 0 if TYPE is NULL. */
1538
1539 static int
1540 desc_arity (struct type *type)
1541 {
1542 type = desc_base_type (type);
1543
1544 if (type != NULL)
1545 return TYPE_NFIELDS (type) / 2;
1546 return 0;
1547 }
1548
1549 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type (not a pointer to one) or
1550 an array descriptor type (representing an unconstrained array
1551 type). */
1552
1553 static int
1554 ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *type)
1555 {
1556 if (type == NULL)
1557 return 0;
1558 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1559 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1560 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type));
1561 }
1562
1563 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents any kind of array in Ada, or a pointer
1564 * to one. */
1565
1566 static int
1567 ada_is_array_type (struct type *type)
1568 {
1569 while (type != NULL
1570 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1571 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1572 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
1573 return ada_is_direct_array_type (type);
1574 }
1575
1576 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type or pointer to one. */
1577
1578 int
1579 ada_is_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1580 {
1581 if (type == NULL)
1582 return 0;
1583 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1584 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1585 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1586 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY));
1587 }
1588
1589 /* Non-zero iff TYPE belongs to a GNAT array descriptor. */
1590
1591 int
1592 ada_is_array_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1593 {
1594 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
1595
1596 if (type == NULL)
1597 return 0;
1598 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1599 return (data_type != NULL
1600 && TYPE_CODE (data_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1601 && desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type)) > 0);
1602 }
1603
1604 /* Non-zero iff type is a partially mal-formed GNAT array
1605 descriptor. FIXME: This is to compensate for some problems with
1606 debugging output from GNAT. Re-examine periodically to see if it
1607 is still needed. */
1608
1609 int
1610 ada_is_bogus_array_descriptor (struct type *type)
1611 {
1612 return
1613 type != NULL
1614 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1615 && (lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL
1616 || lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1) != NULL)
1617 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1618 }
1619
1620
1621 /* If ARR has a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array descriptor,
1622 (fat pointer) returns the type of the array data described---specifically,
1623 a pointer-to-array type. If BOUNDS is non-zero, the bounds data are filled
1624 in from the descriptor; otherwise, they are left unspecified. If
1625 the ARR denotes a null array descriptor and BOUNDS is non-zero,
1626 returns NULL. The result is simply the type of ARR if ARR is not
1627 a descriptor. */
1628 struct type *
1629 ada_type_of_array (struct value *arr, int bounds)
1630 {
1631 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1632 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
1633
1634 if (!ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1635 return value_type (arr);
1636
1637 if (!bounds)
1638 {
1639 struct type *array_type =
1640 ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (value_type (arr)));
1641
1642 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1643 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (array_type, 0) =
1644 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1645
1646 return array_type;
1647 }
1648 else
1649 {
1650 struct type *elt_type;
1651 int arity;
1652 struct value *descriptor;
1653
1654 elt_type = ada_array_element_type (value_type (arr), -1);
1655 arity = ada_array_arity (value_type (arr));
1656
1657 if (elt_type == NULL || arity == 0)
1658 return ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1659
1660 descriptor = desc_bounds (arr);
1661 if (value_as_long (descriptor) == 0)
1662 return NULL;
1663 while (arity > 0)
1664 {
1665 struct type *range_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1666 struct type *array_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1667 struct value *low = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 0);
1668 struct value *high = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 1);
1669 arity -= 1;
1670
1671 create_range_type (range_type, value_type (low),
1672 longest_to_int (value_as_long (low)),
1673 longest_to_int (value_as_long (high)));
1674 elt_type = create_array_type (array_type, elt_type, range_type);
1675
1676 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1677 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) =
1678 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1679 }
1680
1681 return lookup_pointer_type (elt_type);
1682 }
1683 }
1684
1685 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1686 Otherwise, returns either a standard GDB array with bounds set
1687 appropriately or, if ARR is a non-null fat pointer, a pointer to a standard
1688 GDB array. Returns NULL if ARR is a null fat pointer. */
1689
1690 struct value *
1691 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (struct value *arr)
1692 {
1693 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1694 {
1695 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arr, 1);
1696 if (arrType == NULL)
1697 return NULL;
1698 return value_cast (arrType, value_copy (desc_data (arr)));
1699 }
1700 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1701 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
1702 else
1703 return arr;
1704 }
1705
1706 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1707 Otherwise, returns a standard GDB array describing ARR (which may
1708 be ARR itself if it already is in the proper form). */
1709
1710 static struct value *
1711 ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *arr)
1712 {
1713 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1714 {
1715 struct value *arrVal = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (arr);
1716 if (arrVal == NULL)
1717 error (_("Bounds unavailable for null array pointer."));
1718 check_size (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (arrVal)));
1719 return value_ind (arrVal);
1720 }
1721 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1722 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
1723 else
1724 return arr;
1725 }
1726
1727 /* If TYPE represents a GNAT array type, return it translated to an
1728 ordinary GDB array type (possibly with BITSIZE fields indicating
1729 packing). For other types, is the identity. */
1730
1731 struct type *
1732 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1733 {
1734 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
1735 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type);
1736
1737 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
1738 return ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (type));
1739
1740 return type;
1741 }
1742
1743 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT packed-array type. */
1744
1745 static int
1746 ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1747 {
1748 if (type == NULL)
1749 return 0;
1750 type = desc_base_type (type);
1751 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1752 return
1753 ada_type_name (type) != NULL
1754 && strstr (ada_type_name (type), "___XP") != NULL;
1755 }
1756
1757 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT constrained
1758 packed-array type. */
1759
1760 int
1761 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1762 {
1763 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
1764 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1765 }
1766
1767 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents an array descriptor for a
1768 unconstrained packed-array type. */
1769
1770 static int
1771 ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1772 {
1773 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
1774 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1775 }
1776
1777 /* Given that TYPE encodes a packed array type (constrained or unconstrained),
1778 return the size of its elements in bits. */
1779
1780 static long
1781 decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *type)
1782 {
1783 char *raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
1784 char *tail;
1785 long bits;
1786
1787 if (!raw_name)
1788 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
1789
1790 if (!raw_name)
1791 return 0;
1792
1793 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
1794
1795 if (sscanf (tail + sizeof ("___XP") - 1, "%ld", &bits) != 1)
1796 {
1797 lim_warning
1798 (_("could not understand bit size information on packed array"));
1799 return 0;
1800 }
1801
1802 return bits;
1803 }
1804
1805 /* Given that TYPE is a standard GDB array type with all bounds filled
1806 in, and that the element size of its ultimate scalar constituents
1807 (that is, either its elements, or, if it is an array of arrays, its
1808 elements' elements, etc.) is *ELT_BITS, return an identical type,
1809 but with the bit sizes of its elements (and those of any
1810 constituent arrays) recorded in the BITSIZE components of its
1811 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE values, and with *ELT_BITS set to its total size
1812 in bits. */
1813
1814 static struct type *
1815 constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type, long *elt_bits)
1816 {
1817 struct type *new_elt_type;
1818 struct type *new_type;
1819 LONGEST low_bound, high_bound;
1820
1821 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1822 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
1823 return type;
1824
1825 new_type = alloc_type_copy (type);
1826 new_elt_type =
1827 constrained_packed_array_type (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
1828 elt_bits);
1829 create_array_type (new_type, new_elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
1830 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (new_type, 0) = *elt_bits;
1831 TYPE_NAME (new_type) = ada_type_name (type);
1832
1833 if (get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type),
1834 &low_bound, &high_bound) < 0)
1835 low_bound = high_bound = 0;
1836 if (high_bound < low_bound)
1837 *elt_bits = TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) = 0;
1838 else
1839 {
1840 *elt_bits *= (high_bound - low_bound + 1);
1841 TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) =
1842 (*elt_bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
1843 }
1844
1845 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (new_type) = 1;
1846 return new_type;
1847 }
1848
1849 /* The array type encoded by TYPE, where
1850 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (TYPE). */
1851
1852 static struct type *
1853 decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1854 {
1855 struct symbol *sym;
1856 struct block **blocks;
1857 char *raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
1858 char *name;
1859 char *tail;
1860 struct type *shadow_type;
1861 long bits;
1862 int i, n;
1863
1864 if (!raw_name)
1865 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
1866
1867 if (!raw_name)
1868 return NULL;
1869
1870 name = (char *) alloca (strlen (raw_name) + 1);
1871 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
1872 type = desc_base_type (type);
1873
1874 memcpy (name, raw_name, tail - raw_name);
1875 name[tail - raw_name] = '\000';
1876
1877 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (0), VAR_DOMAIN);
1878 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_TYPE (sym) == NULL)
1879 {
1880 lim_warning (_("could not find bounds information on packed array"));
1881 return NULL;
1882 }
1883 shadow_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
1884 CHECK_TYPEDEF (shadow_type);
1885
1886 if (TYPE_CODE (shadow_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
1887 {
1888 lim_warning (_("could not understand bounds information on packed array"));
1889 return NULL;
1890 }
1891
1892 bits = decode_packed_array_bitsize (type);
1893 return constrained_packed_array_type (shadow_type, &bits);
1894 }
1895
1896 /* Given that ARR is a struct value *indicating a GNAT constrained packed
1897 array, returns a simple array that denotes that array. Its type is a
1898 standard GDB array type except that the BITSIZEs of the array
1899 target types are set to the number of bits in each element, and the
1900 type length is set appropriately. */
1901
1902 static struct value *
1903 decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *arr)
1904 {
1905 struct type *type;
1906
1907 arr = ada_coerce_ref (arr);
1908
1909 /* If our value is a pointer, then dererence it. Make sure that
1910 this operation does not cause the target type to be fixed, as
1911 this would indirectly cause this array to be decoded. The rest
1912 of the routine assumes that the array hasn't been decoded yet,
1913 so we use the basic "value_ind" routine to perform the dereferencing,
1914 as opposed to using "ada_value_ind". */
1915 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arr)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1916 arr = value_ind (arr);
1917
1918 type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
1919 if (type == NULL)
1920 {
1921 error (_("can't unpack array"));
1922 return NULL;
1923 }
1924
1925 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (value_type (arr)))
1926 && ada_is_modular_type (value_type (arr)))
1927 {
1928 /* This is a (right-justified) modular type representing a packed
1929 array with no wrapper. In order to interpret the value through
1930 the (left-justified) packed array type we just built, we must
1931 first left-justify it. */
1932 int bit_size, bit_pos;
1933 ULONGEST mod;
1934
1935 mod = ada_modulus (value_type (arr)) - 1;
1936 bit_size = 0;
1937 while (mod > 0)
1938 {
1939 bit_size += 1;
1940 mod >>= 1;
1941 }
1942 bit_pos = HOST_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arr)) - bit_size;
1943 arr = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL,
1944 bit_pos / HOST_CHAR_BIT,
1945 bit_pos % HOST_CHAR_BIT,
1946 bit_size,
1947 type);
1948 }
1949
1950 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (arr, type);
1951 }
1952
1953
1954 /* The value of the element of packed array ARR at the ARITY indices
1955 given in IND. ARR must be a simple array. */
1956
1957 static struct value *
1958 value_subscript_packed (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
1959 {
1960 int i;
1961 int bits, elt_off, bit_off;
1962 long elt_total_bit_offset;
1963 struct type *elt_type;
1964 struct value *v;
1965
1966 bits = 0;
1967 elt_total_bit_offset = 0;
1968 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1969 for (i = 0; i < arity; i += 1)
1970 {
1971 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1972 || TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) == 0)
1973 error
1974 (_("attempt to do packed indexing of something other than a packed array"));
1975 else
1976 {
1977 struct type *range_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
1978 LONGEST lowerbound, upperbound;
1979 LONGEST idx;
1980
1981 if (get_discrete_bounds (range_type, &lowerbound, &upperbound) < 0)
1982 {
1983 lim_warning (_("don't know bounds of array"));
1984 lowerbound = upperbound = 0;
1985 }
1986
1987 idx = pos_atr (ind[i]);
1988 if (idx < lowerbound || idx > upperbound)
1989 lim_warning (_("packed array index %ld out of bounds"), (long) idx);
1990 bits = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
1991 elt_total_bit_offset += (idx - lowerbound) * bits;
1992 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
1993 }
1994 }
1995 elt_off = elt_total_bit_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
1996 bit_off = elt_total_bit_offset % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
1997
1998 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL, elt_off, bit_off,
1999 bits, elt_type);
2000 return v;
2001 }
2002
2003 /* Non-zero iff TYPE includes negative integer values. */
2004
2005 static int
2006 has_negatives (struct type *type)
2007 {
2008 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
2009 {
2010 default:
2011 return 0;
2012 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
2013 return !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
2014 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
2015 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type) < 0;
2016 }
2017 }
2018
2019
2020 /* Create a new value of type TYPE from the contents of OBJ starting
2021 at byte OFFSET, and bit offset BIT_OFFSET within that byte,
2022 proceeding for BIT_SIZE bits. If OBJ is an lval in memory, then
2023 assigning through the result will set the field fetched from.
2024 VALADDR is ignored unless OBJ is NULL, in which case,
2025 VALADDR+OFFSET must address the start of storage containing the
2026 packed value. The value returned in this case is never an lval.
2027 Assumes 0 <= BIT_OFFSET < HOST_CHAR_BIT. */
2028
2029 struct value *
2030 ada_value_primitive_packed_val (struct value *obj, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
2031 long offset, int bit_offset, int bit_size,
2032 struct type *type)
2033 {
2034 struct value *v;
2035 int src, /* Index into the source area */
2036 targ, /* Index into the target area */
2037 srcBitsLeft, /* Number of source bits left to move */
2038 nsrc, ntarg, /* Number of source and target bytes */
2039 unusedLS, /* Number of bits in next significant
2040 byte of source that are unused */
2041 accumSize; /* Number of meaningful bits in accum */
2042 unsigned char *bytes; /* First byte containing data to unpack */
2043 unsigned char *unpacked;
2044 unsigned long accum; /* Staging area for bits being transferred */
2045 unsigned char sign;
2046 int len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8;
2047 /* Transmit bytes from least to most significant; delta is the direction
2048 the indices move. */
2049 int delta = gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)) ? -1 : 1;
2050
2051 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2052
2053 if (obj == NULL)
2054 {
2055 v = allocate_value (type);
2056 bytes = (unsigned char *) (valaddr + offset);
2057 }
2058 else if (VALUE_LVAL (obj) == lval_memory && value_lazy (obj))
2059 {
2060 v = value_at (type,
2061 value_address (obj) + offset);
2062 bytes = (unsigned char *) alloca (len);
2063 read_memory (value_address (v), bytes, len);
2064 }
2065 else
2066 {
2067 v = allocate_value (type);
2068 bytes = (unsigned char *) value_contents (obj) + offset;
2069 }
2070
2071 if (obj != NULL)
2072 {
2073 CORE_ADDR new_addr;
2074 set_value_component_location (v, obj);
2075 new_addr = value_address (obj) + offset;
2076 set_value_bitpos (v, bit_offset + value_bitpos (obj));
2077 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2078 if (value_bitpos (v) >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2079 {
2080 ++new_addr;
2081 set_value_bitpos (v, value_bitpos (v) - HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2082 }
2083 set_value_address (v, new_addr);
2084 }
2085 else
2086 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2087 unpacked = (unsigned char *) value_contents (v);
2088
2089 srcBitsLeft = bit_size;
2090 nsrc = len;
2091 ntarg = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
2092 sign = 0;
2093 if (bit_size == 0)
2094 {
2095 memset (unpacked, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2096 return v;
2097 }
2098 else if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)))
2099 {
2100 src = len - 1;
2101 if (has_negatives (type)
2102 && ((bytes[0] << bit_offset) & (1 << (HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1))))
2103 sign = ~0;
2104
2105 unusedLS =
2106 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - (bit_size + bit_offset) % HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2107 % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2108
2109 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
2110 {
2111 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
2112 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
2113 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
2114 /* Non-scalar values must be aligned at a byte boundary... */
2115 accumSize =
2116 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - bit_size % HOST_CHAR_BIT) % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2117 /* ... And are placed at the beginning (most-significant) bytes
2118 of the target. */
2119 targ = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1;
2120 ntarg = targ + 1;
2121 break;
2122 default:
2123 accumSize = 0;
2124 targ = TYPE_LENGTH (type) - 1;
2125 break;
2126 }
2127 }
2128 else
2129 {
2130 int sign_bit_offset = (bit_size + bit_offset - 1) % 8;
2131
2132 src = targ = 0;
2133 unusedLS = bit_offset;
2134 accumSize = 0;
2135
2136 if (has_negatives (type) && (bytes[len - 1] & (1 << sign_bit_offset)))
2137 sign = ~0;
2138 }
2139
2140 accum = 0;
2141 while (nsrc > 0)
2142 {
2143 /* Mask for removing bits of the next source byte that are not
2144 part of the value. */
2145 unsigned int unusedMSMask =
2146 (1 << (srcBitsLeft >= HOST_CHAR_BIT ? HOST_CHAR_BIT : srcBitsLeft)) -
2147 1;
2148 /* Sign-extend bits for this byte. */
2149 unsigned int signMask = sign & ~unusedMSMask;
2150 accum |=
2151 (((bytes[src] >> unusedLS) & unusedMSMask) | signMask) << accumSize;
2152 accumSize += HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2153 if (accumSize >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2154 {
2155 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2156 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2157 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2158 ntarg -= 1;
2159 targ += delta;
2160 }
2161 srcBitsLeft -= HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2162 unusedLS = 0;
2163 nsrc -= 1;
2164 src += delta;
2165 }
2166 while (ntarg > 0)
2167 {
2168 accum |= sign << accumSize;
2169 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2170 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2171 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2172 ntarg -= 1;
2173 targ += delta;
2174 }
2175
2176 return v;
2177 }
2178
2179 /* Move N bits from SOURCE, starting at bit offset SRC_OFFSET to
2180 TARGET, starting at bit offset TARG_OFFSET. SOURCE and TARGET must
2181 not overlap. */
2182 static void
2183 move_bits (gdb_byte *target, int targ_offset, const gdb_byte *source,
2184 int src_offset, int n, int bits_big_endian_p)
2185 {
2186 unsigned int accum, mask;
2187 int accum_bits, chunk_size;
2188
2189 target += targ_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2190 targ_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2191 source += src_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2192 src_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2193 if (bits_big_endian_p)
2194 {
2195 accum = (unsigned char) *source;
2196 source += 1;
2197 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2198
2199 while (n > 0)
2200 {
2201 int unused_right;
2202 accum = (accum << HOST_CHAR_BIT) + (unsigned char) *source;
2203 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2204 source += 1;
2205 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2206 if (chunk_size > n)
2207 chunk_size = n;
2208 unused_right = HOST_CHAR_BIT - (chunk_size + targ_offset);
2209 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << unused_right;
2210 *target =
2211 (*target & ~mask)
2212 | ((accum >> (accum_bits - chunk_size - unused_right)) & mask);
2213 n -= chunk_size;
2214 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2215 target += 1;
2216 targ_offset = 0;
2217 }
2218 }
2219 else
2220 {
2221 accum = (unsigned char) *source >> src_offset;
2222 source += 1;
2223 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2224
2225 while (n > 0)
2226 {
2227 accum = accum + ((unsigned char) *source << accum_bits);
2228 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2229 source += 1;
2230 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2231 if (chunk_size > n)
2232 chunk_size = n;
2233 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << targ_offset;
2234 *target = (*target & ~mask) | ((accum << targ_offset) & mask);
2235 n -= chunk_size;
2236 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2237 accum >>= chunk_size;
2238 target += 1;
2239 targ_offset = 0;
2240 }
2241 }
2242 }
2243
2244 /* Store the contents of FROMVAL into the location of TOVAL.
2245 Return a new value with the location of TOVAL and contents of
2246 FROMVAL. Handles assignment into packed fields that have
2247 floating-point or non-scalar types. */
2248
2249 static struct value *
2250 ada_value_assign (struct value *toval, struct value *fromval)
2251 {
2252 struct type *type = value_type (toval);
2253 int bits = value_bitsize (toval);
2254
2255 toval = ada_coerce_ref (toval);
2256 fromval = ada_coerce_ref (fromval);
2257
2258 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (toval)))
2259 toval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (toval);
2260 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (fromval)))
2261 fromval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (fromval);
2262
2263 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (toval))
2264 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
2265
2266 if (VALUE_LVAL (toval) == lval_memory
2267 && bits > 0
2268 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT
2269 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT))
2270 {
2271 int len = (value_bitpos (toval)
2272 + bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2273 int from_size;
2274 char *buffer = (char *) alloca (len);
2275 struct value *val;
2276 CORE_ADDR to_addr = value_address (toval);
2277
2278 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
2279 fromval = value_cast (type, fromval);
2280
2281 read_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2282 from_size = value_bitsize (fromval);
2283 if (from_size == 0)
2284 from_size = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (fromval)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
2285 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)))
2286 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2287 value_contents (fromval), from_size - bits, bits, 1);
2288 else
2289 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2290 value_contents (fromval), 0, bits, 0);
2291 write_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2292 observer_notify_memory_changed (to_addr, len, buffer);
2293
2294 val = value_copy (toval);
2295 memcpy (value_contents_raw (val), value_contents (fromval),
2296 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2297 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
2298
2299 return val;
2300 }
2301
2302 return value_assign (toval, fromval);
2303 }
2304
2305
2306 /* Given that COMPONENT is a memory lvalue that is part of the lvalue
2307 * CONTAINER, assign the contents of VAL to COMPONENTS's place in
2308 * CONTAINER. Modifies the VALUE_CONTENTS of CONTAINER only, not
2309 * COMPONENT, and not the inferior's memory. The current contents
2310 * of COMPONENT are ignored. */
2311 static void
2312 value_assign_to_component (struct value *container, struct value *component,
2313 struct value *val)
2314 {
2315 LONGEST offset_in_container =
2316 (LONGEST) (value_address (component) - value_address (container));
2317 int bit_offset_in_container =
2318 value_bitpos (component) - value_bitpos (container);
2319 int bits;
2320
2321 val = value_cast (value_type (component), val);
2322
2323 if (value_bitsize (component) == 0)
2324 bits = TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component));
2325 else
2326 bits = value_bitsize (component);
2327
2328 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (value_type (container))))
2329 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2330 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2331 value_contents (val),
2332 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT - bits,
2333 bits, 1);
2334 else
2335 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2336 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2337 value_contents (val), 0, bits, 0);
2338 }
2339
2340 /* The value of the element of array ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND.
2341 ARR may be either a simple array, GNAT array descriptor, or pointer
2342 thereto. */
2343
2344 struct value *
2345 ada_value_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2346 {
2347 int k;
2348 struct value *elt;
2349 struct type *elt_type;
2350
2351 elt = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arr);
2352
2353 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (elt));
2354 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2355 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) > 0)
2356 return value_subscript_packed (elt, arity, ind);
2357
2358 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2359 {
2360 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2361 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2362 elt = value_subscript (elt, pos_atr (ind[k]));
2363 }
2364 return elt;
2365 }
2366
2367 /* Assuming ARR is a pointer to a standard GDB array of type TYPE, the
2368 value of the element of *ARR at the ARITY indices given in
2369 IND. Does not read the entire array into memory. */
2370
2371 static struct value *
2372 ada_value_ptr_subscript (struct value *arr, struct type *type, int arity,
2373 struct value **ind)
2374 {
2375 int k;
2376
2377 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2378 {
2379 LONGEST lwb, upb;
2380
2381 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2382 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2383 arr = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2384 value_copy (arr));
2385 get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), &lwb, &upb);
2386 arr = value_ptradd (arr, pos_atr (ind[k]) - lwb);
2387 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2388 }
2389
2390 return value_ind (arr);
2391 }
2392
2393 /* Given that ARRAY_PTR is a pointer or reference to an array of type TYPE (the
2394 actual type of ARRAY_PTR is ignored), returns the Ada slice of HIGH-LOW+1
2395 elements starting at index LOW. The lower bound of this array is LOW, as
2396 per Ada rules. */
2397 static struct value *
2398 ada_value_slice_from_ptr (struct value *array_ptr, struct type *type,
2399 int low, int high)
2400 {
2401 CORE_ADDR base = value_as_address (array_ptr)
2402 + ((low - ada_discrete_type_low_bound (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type)))
2403 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
2404 struct type *index_type =
2405 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type)),
2406 low, high);
2407 struct type *slice_type =
2408 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type);
2409 return value_at_lazy (slice_type, base);
2410 }
2411
2412
2413 static struct value *
2414 ada_value_slice (struct value *array, int low, int high)
2415 {
2416 struct type *type = value_type (array);
2417 struct type *index_type =
2418 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), low, high);
2419 struct type *slice_type =
2420 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type);
2421 return value_cast (slice_type, value_slice (array, low, high - low + 1));
2422 }
2423
2424 /* If type is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2425 descriptor, returns the number of dimensions for type. If arr is a
2426 simple array, returns the number of "array of"s that prefix its
2427 type designation. Otherwise, returns 0. */
2428
2429 int
2430 ada_array_arity (struct type *type)
2431 {
2432 int arity;
2433
2434 if (type == NULL)
2435 return 0;
2436
2437 type = desc_base_type (type);
2438
2439 arity = 0;
2440 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2441 return desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type));
2442 else
2443 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2444 {
2445 arity += 1;
2446 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
2447 }
2448
2449 return arity;
2450 }
2451
2452 /* If TYPE is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2453 descriptor or a simple array type, returns the element type for
2454 TYPE after indexing by NINDICES indices, or by all indices if
2455 NINDICES is -1. Otherwise, returns NULL. */
2456
2457 struct type *
2458 ada_array_element_type (struct type *type, int nindices)
2459 {
2460 type = desc_base_type (type);
2461
2462 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2463 {
2464 int k;
2465 struct type *p_array_type;
2466
2467 p_array_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
2468
2469 k = ada_array_arity (type);
2470 if (k == 0)
2471 return NULL;
2472
2473 /* Initially p_array_type = elt_type(*)[]...(k times)...[]. */
2474 if (nindices >= 0 && k > nindices)
2475 k = nindices;
2476 while (k > 0 && p_array_type != NULL)
2477 {
2478 p_array_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_array_type));
2479 k -= 1;
2480 }
2481 return p_array_type;
2482 }
2483 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2484 {
2485 while (nindices != 0 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2486 {
2487 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2488 nindices -= 1;
2489 }
2490 return type;
2491 }
2492
2493 return NULL;
2494 }
2495
2496 /* The type of nth index in arrays of given type (n numbering from 1).
2497 Does not examine memory. Throws an error if N is invalid or TYPE
2498 is not an array type. NAME is the name of the Ada attribute being
2499 evaluated ('range, 'first, 'last, or 'length); it is used in building
2500 the error message. */
2501
2502 static struct type *
2503 ada_index_type (struct type *type, int n, const char *name)
2504 {
2505 struct type *result_type;
2506
2507 type = desc_base_type (type);
2508
2509 if (n < 0 || n > ada_array_arity (type))
2510 error (_("invalid dimension number to '%s"), name);
2511
2512 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (type))
2513 {
2514 int i;
2515
2516 for (i = 1; i < n; i += 1)
2517 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2518 result_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
2519 /* FIXME: The stabs type r(0,0);bound;bound in an array type
2520 has a target type of TYPE_CODE_UNDEF. We compensate here, but
2521 perhaps stabsread.c would make more sense. */
2522 if (result_type && TYPE_CODE (result_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF)
2523 result_type = NULL;
2524 }
2525 else
2526 {
2527 result_type = desc_index_type (desc_bounds_type (type), n);
2528 if (result_type == NULL)
2529 error (_("attempt to take bound of something that is not an array"));
2530 }
2531
2532 return result_type;
2533 }
2534
2535 /* Given that arr is an array type, returns the lower bound of the
2536 Nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2537 WHICH is 1. This returns bounds 0 .. -1 if ARR_TYPE is an
2538 array-descriptor type. It works for other arrays with bounds supplied
2539 by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2540
2541 static LONGEST
2542 ada_array_bound_from_type (struct type * arr_type, int n, int which)
2543 {
2544 struct type *type, *elt_type, *index_type_desc, *index_type;
2545 int i;
2546
2547 gdb_assert (which == 0 || which == 1);
2548
2549 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2550 arr_type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type);
2551
2552 if (arr_type == NULL || !ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2553 return (LONGEST) - which;
2554
2555 if (TYPE_CODE (arr_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2556 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (arr_type);
2557 else
2558 type = arr_type;
2559
2560 elt_type = type;
2561 for (i = n; i > 1; i--)
2562 elt_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2563
2564 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2565 if (index_type_desc != NULL)
2566 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_type_desc, n - 1),
2567 NULL, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type));
2568 else
2569 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
2570
2571 return
2572 (LONGEST) (which == 0
2573 ? ada_discrete_type_low_bound (index_type)
2574 : ada_discrete_type_high_bound (index_type));
2575 }
2576
2577 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the lower bound of the
2578 nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2579 WHICH is 1. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
2580 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2581
2582 static LONGEST
2583 ada_array_bound (struct value *arr, int n, int which)
2584 {
2585 struct type *arr_type = value_type (arr);
2586
2587 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2588 return ada_array_bound (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n, which);
2589 else if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2590 return ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, which);
2591 else
2592 return value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, which));
2593 }
2594
2595 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the length of the
2596 nth index. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
2597 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants.
2598 Does not work for arrays indexed by enumeration types with representation
2599 clauses at the moment. */
2600
2601 static LONGEST
2602 ada_array_length (struct value *arr, int n)
2603 {
2604 struct type *arr_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
2605
2606 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2607 return ada_array_length (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n);
2608
2609 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2610 return (ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 1)
2611 - ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 0) + 1);
2612 else
2613 return (value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 1))
2614 - value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 0)) + 1);
2615 }
2616
2617 /* An empty array whose type is that of ARR_TYPE (an array type),
2618 with bounds LOW to LOW-1. */
2619
2620 static struct value *
2621 empty_array (struct type *arr_type, int low)
2622 {
2623 struct type *index_type =
2624 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (arr_type)),
2625 low, low - 1);
2626 struct type *elt_type = ada_array_element_type (arr_type, 1);
2627 return allocate_value (create_array_type (NULL, elt_type, index_type));
2628 }
2629 \f
2630
2631 /* Name resolution */
2632
2633 /* The "decoded" name for the user-definable Ada operator corresponding
2634 to OP. */
2635
2636 static const char *
2637 ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode op)
2638 {
2639 int i;
2640
2641 for (i = 0; ada_opname_table[i].encoded != NULL; i += 1)
2642 {
2643 if (ada_opname_table[i].op == op)
2644 return ada_opname_table[i].decoded;
2645 }
2646 error (_("Could not find operator name for opcode"));
2647 }
2648
2649
2650 /* Same as evaluate_type (*EXP), but resolves ambiguous symbol
2651 references (marked by OP_VAR_VALUE nodes in which the symbol has an
2652 undefined namespace) and converts operators that are
2653 user-defined into appropriate function calls. If CONTEXT_TYPE is
2654 non-null, it provides a preferred result type [at the moment, only
2655 type void has any effect---causing procedures to be preferred over
2656 functions in calls]. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates that a non-void
2657 return type is preferred. May change (expand) *EXP. */
2658
2659 static void
2660 resolve (struct expression **expp, int void_context_p)
2661 {
2662 struct type *context_type = NULL;
2663 int pc = 0;
2664
2665 if (void_context_p)
2666 context_type = builtin_type ((*expp)->gdbarch)->builtin_void;
2667
2668 resolve_subexp (expp, &pc, 1, context_type);
2669 }
2670
2671 /* Resolve the operator of the subexpression beginning at
2672 position *POS of *EXPP. "Resolving" consists of replacing
2673 the symbols that have undefined namespaces in OP_VAR_VALUE nodes
2674 with their resolutions, replacing built-in operators with
2675 function calls to user-defined operators, where appropriate, and,
2676 when DEPROCEDURE_P is non-zero, converting function-valued variables
2677 into parameterless calls. May expand *EXPP. The CONTEXT_TYPE functions
2678 are as in ada_resolve, above. */
2679
2680 static struct value *
2681 resolve_subexp (struct expression **expp, int *pos, int deprocedure_p,
2682 struct type *context_type)
2683 {
2684 int pc = *pos;
2685 int i;
2686 struct expression *exp; /* Convenience: == *expp. */
2687 enum exp_opcode op = (*expp)->elts[pc].opcode;
2688 struct value **argvec; /* Vector of operand types (alloca'ed). */
2689 int nargs; /* Number of operands. */
2690 int oplen;
2691
2692 argvec = NULL;
2693 nargs = 0;
2694 exp = *expp;
2695
2696 /* Pass one: resolve operands, saving their types and updating *pos,
2697 if needed. */
2698 switch (op)
2699 {
2700 case OP_FUNCALL:
2701 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
2702 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
2703 *pos += 7;
2704 else
2705 {
2706 *pos += 3;
2707 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2708 }
2709 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
2710 break;
2711
2712 case UNOP_ADDR:
2713 *pos += 1;
2714 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2715 break;
2716
2717 case UNOP_QUAL:
2718 *pos += 3;
2719 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type));
2720 break;
2721
2722 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
2723 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
2724 case OP_ATR_TAG:
2725 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
2726 case OP_ATR_LAST:
2727 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
2728 case OP_ATR_POS:
2729 case OP_ATR_VAL:
2730 case OP_ATR_MIN:
2731 case OP_ATR_MAX:
2732 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
2733 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
2734 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
2735 case OP_AGGREGATE:
2736 case OP_OTHERS:
2737 case OP_CHOICES:
2738 case OP_POSITIONAL:
2739 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
2740 case OP_NAME:
2741 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
2742 *pos += oplen;
2743 break;
2744
2745 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
2746 {
2747 struct value *arg1;
2748
2749 *pos += 1;
2750 arg1 = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2751 if (arg1 == NULL)
2752 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
2753 else
2754 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, value_type (arg1));
2755 break;
2756 }
2757
2758 case UNOP_CAST:
2759 *pos += 3;
2760 nargs = 1;
2761 break;
2762
2763 case BINOP_ADD:
2764 case BINOP_SUB:
2765 case BINOP_MUL:
2766 case BINOP_DIV:
2767 case BINOP_REM:
2768 case BINOP_MOD:
2769 case BINOP_EXP:
2770 case BINOP_CONCAT:
2771 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
2772 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
2773 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
2774 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
2775 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
2776
2777 case BINOP_EQUAL:
2778 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
2779 case BINOP_LESS:
2780 case BINOP_GTR:
2781 case BINOP_LEQ:
2782 case BINOP_GEQ:
2783
2784 case BINOP_REPEAT:
2785 case BINOP_SUBSCRIPT:
2786 case BINOP_COMMA:
2787 *pos += 1;
2788 nargs = 2;
2789 break;
2790
2791 case UNOP_NEG:
2792 case UNOP_PLUS:
2793 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
2794 case UNOP_ABS:
2795 case UNOP_IND:
2796 *pos += 1;
2797 nargs = 1;
2798 break;
2799
2800 case OP_LONG:
2801 case OP_DOUBLE:
2802 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
2803 *pos += 4;
2804 break;
2805
2806 case OP_TYPE:
2807 case OP_BOOL:
2808 case OP_LAST:
2809 case OP_INTERNALVAR:
2810 *pos += 3;
2811 break;
2812
2813 case UNOP_MEMVAL:
2814 *pos += 3;
2815 nargs = 1;
2816 break;
2817
2818 case OP_REGISTER:
2819 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
2820 break;
2821
2822 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
2823 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
2824 nargs = 1;
2825 break;
2826
2827 case TERNOP_SLICE:
2828 *pos += 1;
2829 nargs = 3;
2830 break;
2831
2832 case OP_STRING:
2833 break;
2834
2835 default:
2836 error (_("Unexpected operator during name resolution"));
2837 }
2838
2839 argvec = (struct value * *) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 1));
2840 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
2841 argvec[i] = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
2842 argvec[i] = NULL;
2843 exp = *expp;
2844
2845 /* Pass two: perform any resolution on principal operator. */
2846 switch (op)
2847 {
2848 default:
2849 break;
2850
2851 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
2852 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
2853 {
2854 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
2855 int n_candidates;
2856
2857 n_candidates =
2858 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
2859 (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
2860 exp->elts[pc + 1].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
2861 &candidates);
2862
2863 if (n_candidates > 1)
2864 {
2865 /* Types tend to get re-introduced locally, so if there
2866 are any local symbols that are not types, first filter
2867 out all types. */
2868 int j;
2869 for (j = 0; j < n_candidates; j += 1)
2870 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym))
2871 {
2872 case LOC_REGISTER:
2873 case LOC_ARG:
2874 case LOC_REF_ARG:
2875 case LOC_REGPARM_ADDR:
2876 case LOC_LOCAL:
2877 case LOC_COMPUTED:
2878 goto FoundNonType;
2879 default:
2880 break;
2881 }
2882 FoundNonType:
2883 if (j < n_candidates)
2884 {
2885 j = 0;
2886 while (j < n_candidates)
2887 {
2888 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
2889 {
2890 candidates[j] = candidates[n_candidates - 1];
2891 n_candidates -= 1;
2892 }
2893 else
2894 j += 1;
2895 }
2896 }
2897 }
2898
2899 if (n_candidates == 0)
2900 error (_("No definition found for %s"),
2901 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
2902 else if (n_candidates == 1)
2903 i = 0;
2904 else if (deprocedure_p
2905 && !is_nonfunction (candidates, n_candidates))
2906 {
2907 i = ada_resolve_function
2908 (candidates, n_candidates, NULL, 0,
2909 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
2910 context_type);
2911 if (i < 0)
2912 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
2913 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
2914 }
2915 else
2916 {
2917 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"),
2918 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
2919 user_select_syms (candidates, n_candidates, 1);
2920 i = 0;
2921 }
2922
2923 exp->elts[pc + 1].block = candidates[i].block;
2924 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
2925 if (innermost_block == NULL
2926 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
2927 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
2928 }
2929
2930 if (deprocedure_p
2931 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))
2932 == TYPE_CODE_FUNC))
2933 {
2934 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, 0, 0,
2935 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol,
2936 exp->elts[pc + 1].block);
2937 exp = *expp;
2938 }
2939 break;
2940
2941 case OP_FUNCALL:
2942 {
2943 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
2944 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
2945 {
2946 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
2947 int n_candidates;
2948
2949 n_candidates =
2950 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
2951 (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
2952 exp->elts[pc + 4].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
2953 &candidates);
2954 if (n_candidates == 1)
2955 i = 0;
2956 else
2957 {
2958 i = ada_resolve_function
2959 (candidates, n_candidates,
2960 argvec, nargs,
2961 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
2962 context_type);
2963 if (i < 0)
2964 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
2965 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
2966 }
2967
2968 exp->elts[pc + 4].block = candidates[i].block;
2969 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
2970 if (innermost_block == NULL
2971 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
2972 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
2973 }
2974 }
2975 break;
2976 case BINOP_ADD:
2977 case BINOP_SUB:
2978 case BINOP_MUL:
2979 case BINOP_DIV:
2980 case BINOP_REM:
2981 case BINOP_MOD:
2982 case BINOP_CONCAT:
2983 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
2984 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
2985 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
2986 case BINOP_EQUAL:
2987 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
2988 case BINOP_LESS:
2989 case BINOP_GTR:
2990 case BINOP_LEQ:
2991 case BINOP_GEQ:
2992 case BINOP_EXP:
2993 case UNOP_NEG:
2994 case UNOP_PLUS:
2995 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
2996 case UNOP_ABS:
2997 if (possible_user_operator_p (op, argvec))
2998 {
2999 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
3000 int n_candidates;
3001
3002 n_candidates =
3003 ada_lookup_symbol_list (ada_encode (ada_decoded_op_name (op)),
3004 (struct block *) NULL, VAR_DOMAIN,
3005 &candidates);
3006 i = ada_resolve_function (candidates, n_candidates, argvec, nargs,
3007 ada_decoded_op_name (op), NULL);
3008 if (i < 0)
3009 break;
3010
3011 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, nargs, 1,
3012 candidates[i].sym, candidates[i].block);
3013 exp = *expp;
3014 }
3015 break;
3016
3017 case OP_TYPE:
3018 case OP_REGISTER:
3019 return NULL;
3020 }
3021
3022 *pos = pc;
3023 return evaluate_subexp_type (exp, pos);
3024 }
3025
3026 /* Return non-zero if formal type FTYPE matches actual type ATYPE. If
3027 MAY_DEREF is non-zero, the formal may be a pointer and the actual
3028 a non-pointer. */
3029 /* The term "match" here is rather loose. The match is heuristic and
3030 liberal. */
3031
3032 static int
3033 ada_type_match (struct type *ftype, struct type *atype, int may_deref)
3034 {
3035 ftype = ada_check_typedef (ftype);
3036 atype = ada_check_typedef (atype);
3037
3038 if (TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3039 ftype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype);
3040 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3041 atype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype);
3042
3043 switch (TYPE_CODE (ftype))
3044 {
3045 default:
3046 return TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE (atype);
3047 case TYPE_CODE_PTR:
3048 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3049 return ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype),
3050 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype), 0);
3051 else
3052 return (may_deref
3053 && ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype), atype, 0));
3054 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3055 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3056 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3057 switch (TYPE_CODE (atype))
3058 {
3059 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3060 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3061 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3062 return 1;
3063 default:
3064 return 0;
3065 }
3066
3067 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
3068 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3069 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3070
3071 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
3072 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ftype))
3073 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3074 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3075 else
3076 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
3077 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3078
3079 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
3080 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3081 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE (ftype));
3082 }
3083 }
3084
3085 /* Return non-zero if the formals of FUNC "sufficiently match" the
3086 vector of actual argument types ACTUALS of size N_ACTUALS. FUNC
3087 may also be an enumeral, in which case it is treated as a 0-
3088 argument function. */
3089
3090 static int
3091 ada_args_match (struct symbol *func, struct value **actuals, int n_actuals)
3092 {
3093 int i;
3094 struct type *func_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (func);
3095
3096 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (func) == LOC_CONST
3097 && TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3098 return (n_actuals == 0);
3099 else if (func_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (func_type) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3100 return 0;
3101
3102 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (func_type) != n_actuals)
3103 return 0;
3104
3105 for (i = 0; i < n_actuals; i += 1)
3106 {
3107 if (actuals[i] == NULL)
3108 return 0;
3109 else
3110 {
3111 struct type *ftype = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (func_type, i));
3112 struct type *atype = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actuals[i]));
3113
3114 if (!ada_type_match (ftype, atype, 1))
3115 return 0;
3116 }
3117 }
3118 return 1;
3119 }
3120
3121 /* False iff function type FUNC_TYPE definitely does not produce a value
3122 compatible with type CONTEXT_TYPE. Conservatively returns 1 if
3123 FUNC_TYPE is not a valid function type with a non-null return type
3124 or an enumerated type. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates any non-void type. */
3125
3126 static int
3127 return_match (struct type *func_type, struct type *context_type)
3128 {
3129 struct type *return_type;
3130
3131 if (func_type == NULL)
3132 return 1;
3133
3134 if (TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3135 return_type = base_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (func_type));
3136 else
3137 return_type = base_type (func_type);
3138 if (return_type == NULL)
3139 return 1;
3140
3141 context_type = base_type (context_type);
3142
3143 if (TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3144 return context_type == NULL || return_type == context_type;
3145 else if (context_type == NULL)
3146 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID;
3147 else
3148 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE (context_type);
3149 }
3150
3151
3152 /* Returns the index in SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] that contains the symbol for the
3153 function (if any) that matches the types of the NARGS arguments in
3154 ARGS. If CONTEXT_TYPE is non-null and there is at least one match
3155 that returns that type, then eliminate matches that don't. If
3156 CONTEXT_TYPE is void and there is at least one match that does not
3157 return void, eliminate all matches that do.
3158
3159 Asks the user if there is more than one match remaining. Returns -1
3160 if there is no such symbol or none is selected. NAME is used
3161 solely for messages. May re-arrange and modify SYMS in
3162 the process; the index returned is for the modified vector. */
3163
3164 static int
3165 ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info syms[],
3166 int nsyms, struct value **args, int nargs,
3167 const char *name, struct type *context_type)
3168 {
3169 int fallback;
3170 int k;
3171 int m; /* Number of hits */
3172
3173 m = 0;
3174 /* In the first pass of the loop, we only accept functions matching
3175 context_type. If none are found, we add a second pass of the loop
3176 where every function is accepted. */
3177 for (fallback = 0; m == 0 && fallback < 2; fallback++)
3178 {
3179 for (k = 0; k < nsyms; k += 1)
3180 {
3181 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[k].sym));
3182
3183 if (ada_args_match (syms[k].sym, args, nargs)
3184 && (fallback || return_match (type, context_type)))
3185 {
3186 syms[m] = syms[k];
3187 m += 1;
3188 }
3189 }
3190 }
3191
3192 if (m == 0)
3193 return -1;
3194 else if (m > 1)
3195 {
3196 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"), name);
3197 user_select_syms (syms, m, 1);
3198 return 0;
3199 }
3200 return 0;
3201 }
3202
3203 /* Returns true (non-zero) iff decoded name N0 should appear before N1
3204 in a listing of choices during disambiguation (see sort_choices, below).
3205 The idea is that overloadings of a subprogram name from the
3206 same package should sort in their source order. We settle for ordering
3207 such symbols by their trailing number (__N or $N). */
3208
3209 static int
3210 encoded_ordered_before (char *N0, char *N1)
3211 {
3212 if (N1 == NULL)
3213 return 0;
3214 else if (N0 == NULL)
3215 return 1;
3216 else
3217 {
3218 int k0, k1;
3219 for (k0 = strlen (N0) - 1; k0 > 0 && isdigit (N0[k0]); k0 -= 1)
3220 ;
3221 for (k1 = strlen (N1) - 1; k1 > 0 && isdigit (N1[k1]); k1 -= 1)
3222 ;
3223 if ((N0[k0] == '_' || N0[k0] == '$') && N0[k0 + 1] != '\000'
3224 && (N1[k1] == '_' || N1[k1] == '$') && N1[k1 + 1] != '\000')
3225 {
3226 int n0, n1;
3227 n0 = k0;
3228 while (N0[n0] == '_' && n0 > 0 && N0[n0 - 1] == '_')
3229 n0 -= 1;
3230 n1 = k1;
3231 while (N1[n1] == '_' && n1 > 0 && N1[n1 - 1] == '_')
3232 n1 -= 1;
3233 if (n0 == n1 && strncmp (N0, N1, n0) == 0)
3234 return (atoi (N0 + k0 + 1) < atoi (N1 + k1 + 1));
3235 }
3236 return (strcmp (N0, N1) < 0);
3237 }
3238 }
3239
3240 /* Sort SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] to put the choices in a canonical order by the
3241 encoded names. */
3242
3243 static void
3244 sort_choices (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int nsyms)
3245 {
3246 int i;
3247 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3248 {
3249 struct ada_symbol_info sym = syms[i];
3250 int j;
3251
3252 for (j = i - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
3253 {
3254 if (encoded_ordered_before (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
3255 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym.sym)))
3256 break;
3257 syms[j + 1] = syms[j];
3258 }
3259 syms[j + 1] = sym;
3260 }
3261 }
3262
3263 /* Given a list of NSYMS symbols in SYMS, select up to MAX_RESULTS>0
3264 by asking the user (if necessary), returning the number selected,
3265 and setting the first elements of SYMS items. Error if no symbols
3266 selected. */
3267
3268 /* NOTE: Adapted from decode_line_2 in symtab.c, with which it ought
3269 to be re-integrated one of these days. */
3270
3271 int
3272 user_select_syms (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms, int max_results)
3273 {
3274 int i;
3275 int *chosen = (int *) alloca (sizeof (int) * nsyms);
3276 int n_chosen;
3277 int first_choice = (max_results == 1) ? 1 : 2;
3278 const char *select_mode = multiple_symbols_select_mode ();
3279
3280 if (max_results < 1)
3281 error (_("Request to select 0 symbols!"));
3282 if (nsyms <= 1)
3283 return nsyms;
3284
3285 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_cancel)
3286 error (_("\
3287 canceled because the command is ambiguous\n\
3288 See set/show multiple-symbol."));
3289
3290 /* If select_mode is "all", then return all possible symbols.
3291 Only do that if more than one symbol can be selected, of course.
3292 Otherwise, display the menu as usual. */
3293 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_all && max_results > 1)
3294 return nsyms;
3295
3296 printf_unfiltered (_("[0] cancel\n"));
3297 if (max_results > 1)
3298 printf_unfiltered (_("[1] all\n"));
3299
3300 sort_choices (syms, nsyms);
3301
3302 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3303 {
3304 if (syms[i].sym == NULL)
3305 continue;
3306
3307 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_BLOCK)
3308 {
3309 struct symtab_and_line sal =
3310 find_function_start_sal (syms[i].sym, 1);
3311 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
3312 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at <no source file available>:%d\n"),
3313 i + first_choice,
3314 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3315 sal.line);
3316 else
3317 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"), i + first_choice,
3318 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3319 sal.symtab->filename, sal.line);
3320 continue;
3321 }
3322 else
3323 {
3324 int is_enumeral =
3325 (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_CONST
3326 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym) != NULL
3327 && TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM);
3328 struct symtab *symtab = syms[i].sym->symtab;
3329
3330 if (SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym) != 0 && symtab != NULL)
3331 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"),
3332 i + first_choice,
3333 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3334 symtab->filename, SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym));
3335 else if (is_enumeral
3336 && TYPE_NAME (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != NULL)
3337 {
3338 printf_unfiltered (("[%d] "), i + first_choice);
3339 ada_print_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym), NULL,
3340 gdb_stdout, -1, 0);
3341 printf_unfiltered (_("'(%s) (enumeral)\n"),
3342 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3343 }
3344 else if (symtab != NULL)
3345 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3346 ? _("[%d] %s in %s (enumeral)\n")
3347 : _("[%d] %s at %s:?\n"),
3348 i + first_choice,
3349 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3350 symtab->filename);
3351 else
3352 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3353 ? _("[%d] %s (enumeral)\n")
3354 : _("[%d] %s at ?\n"),
3355 i + first_choice,
3356 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3357 }
3358 }
3359
3360 n_chosen = get_selections (chosen, nsyms, max_results, max_results > 1,
3361 "overload-choice");
3362
3363 for (i = 0; i < n_chosen; i += 1)
3364 syms[i] = syms[chosen[i]];
3365
3366 return n_chosen;
3367 }
3368
3369 /* Read and validate a set of numeric choices from the user in the
3370 range 0 .. N_CHOICES-1. Place the results in increasing
3371 order in CHOICES[0 .. N-1], and return N.
3372
3373 The user types choices as a sequence of numbers on one line
3374 separated by blanks, encoding them as follows:
3375
3376 + A choice of 0 means to cancel the selection, throwing an error.
3377 + If IS_ALL_CHOICE, a choice of 1 selects the entire set 0 .. N_CHOICES-1.
3378 + The user chooses k by typing k+IS_ALL_CHOICE+1.
3379
3380 The user is not allowed to choose more than MAX_RESULTS values.
3381
3382 ANNOTATION_SUFFIX, if present, is used to annotate the input
3383 prompts (for use with the -f switch). */
3384
3385 int
3386 get_selections (int *choices, int n_choices, int max_results,
3387 int is_all_choice, char *annotation_suffix)
3388 {
3389 char *args;
3390 char *prompt;
3391 int n_chosen;
3392 int first_choice = is_all_choice ? 2 : 1;
3393
3394 prompt = getenv ("PS2");
3395 if (prompt == NULL)
3396 prompt = "> ";
3397
3398 args = command_line_input (prompt, 0, annotation_suffix);
3399
3400 if (args == NULL)
3401 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3402
3403 n_chosen = 0;
3404
3405 /* Set choices[0 .. n_chosen-1] to the users' choices in ascending
3406 order, as given in args. Choices are validated. */
3407 while (1)
3408 {
3409 char *args2;
3410 int choice, j;
3411
3412 while (isspace (*args))
3413 args += 1;
3414 if (*args == '\0' && n_chosen == 0)
3415 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3416 else if (*args == '\0')
3417 break;
3418
3419 choice = strtol (args, &args2, 10);
3420 if (args == args2 || choice < 0
3421 || choice > n_choices + first_choice - 1)
3422 error (_("Argument must be choice number"));
3423 args = args2;
3424
3425 if (choice == 0)
3426 error (_("cancelled"));
3427
3428 if (choice < first_choice)
3429 {
3430 n_chosen = n_choices;
3431 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
3432 choices[j] = j;
3433 break;
3434 }
3435 choice -= first_choice;
3436
3437 for (j = n_chosen - 1; j >= 0 && choice < choices[j]; j -= 1)
3438 {
3439 }
3440
3441 if (j < 0 || choice != choices[j])
3442 {
3443 int k;
3444 for (k = n_chosen - 1; k > j; k -= 1)
3445 choices[k + 1] = choices[k];
3446 choices[j + 1] = choice;
3447 n_chosen += 1;
3448 }
3449 }
3450
3451 if (n_chosen > max_results)
3452 error (_("Select no more than %d of the above"), max_results);
3453
3454 return n_chosen;
3455 }
3456
3457 /* Replace the operator of length OPLEN at position PC in *EXPP with a call
3458 on the function identified by SYM and BLOCK, and taking NARGS
3459 arguments. Update *EXPP as needed to hold more space. */
3460
3461 static void
3462 replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **expp, int pc, int nargs,
3463 int oplen, struct symbol *sym,
3464 struct block *block)
3465 {
3466 /* A new expression, with 6 more elements (3 for funcall, 4 for function
3467 symbol, -oplen for operator being replaced). */
3468 struct expression *newexp = (struct expression *)
3469 xmalloc (sizeof (struct expression)
3470 + EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES ((*expp)->nelts + 7 - oplen));
3471 struct expression *exp = *expp;
3472
3473 newexp->nelts = exp->nelts + 7 - oplen;
3474 newexp->language_defn = exp->language_defn;
3475 memcpy (newexp->elts, exp->elts, EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (pc));
3476 memcpy (newexp->elts + pc + 7, exp->elts + pc + oplen,
3477 EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (exp->nelts - pc - oplen));
3478
3479 newexp->elts[pc].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 2].opcode = OP_FUNCALL;
3480 newexp->elts[pc + 1].longconst = (LONGEST) nargs;
3481
3482 newexp->elts[pc + 3].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 6].opcode = OP_VAR_VALUE;
3483 newexp->elts[pc + 4].block = block;
3484 newexp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = sym;
3485
3486 *expp = newexp;
3487 xfree (exp);
3488 }
3489
3490 /* Type-class predicates */
3491
3492 /* True iff TYPE is numeric (i.e., an INT, RANGE (of numeric type),
3493 or FLOAT). */
3494
3495 static int
3496 numeric_type_p (struct type *type)
3497 {
3498 if (type == NULL)
3499 return 0;
3500 else
3501 {
3502 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3503 {
3504 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3505 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3506 return 1;
3507 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3508 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
3509 || numeric_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
3510 default:
3511 return 0;
3512 }
3513 }
3514 }
3515
3516 /* True iff TYPE is integral (an INT or RANGE of INTs). */
3517
3518 static int
3519 integer_type_p (struct type *type)
3520 {
3521 if (type == NULL)
3522 return 0;
3523 else
3524 {
3525 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3526 {
3527 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3528 return 1;
3529 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3530 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
3531 || integer_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
3532 default:
3533 return 0;
3534 }
3535 }
3536 }
3537
3538 /* True iff TYPE is scalar (INT, RANGE, FLOAT, ENUM). */
3539
3540 static int
3541 scalar_type_p (struct type *type)
3542 {
3543 if (type == NULL)
3544 return 0;
3545 else
3546 {
3547 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3548 {
3549 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3550 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3551 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3552 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3553 return 1;
3554 default:
3555 return 0;
3556 }
3557 }
3558 }
3559
3560 /* True iff TYPE is discrete (INT, RANGE, ENUM). */
3561
3562 static int
3563 discrete_type_p (struct type *type)
3564 {
3565 if (type == NULL)
3566 return 0;
3567 else
3568 {
3569 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3570 {
3571 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3572 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3573 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3574 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
3575 return 1;
3576 default:
3577 return 0;
3578 }
3579 }
3580 }
3581
3582 /* Returns non-zero if OP with operands in the vector ARGS could be
3583 a user-defined function. Errs on the side of pre-defined operators
3584 (i.e., result 0). */
3585
3586 static int
3587 possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode op, struct value *args[])
3588 {
3589 struct type *type0 =
3590 (args[0] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[0]));
3591 struct type *type1 =
3592 (args[1] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[1]));
3593
3594 if (type0 == NULL)
3595 return 0;
3596
3597 switch (op)
3598 {
3599 default:
3600 return 0;
3601
3602 case BINOP_ADD:
3603 case BINOP_SUB:
3604 case BINOP_MUL:
3605 case BINOP_DIV:
3606 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && numeric_type_p (type1)));
3607
3608 case BINOP_REM:
3609 case BINOP_MOD:
3610 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3611 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3612 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3613 return (!(integer_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
3614
3615 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3616 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3617 case BINOP_LESS:
3618 case BINOP_GTR:
3619 case BINOP_LEQ:
3620 case BINOP_GEQ:
3621 return (!(scalar_type_p (type0) && scalar_type_p (type1)));
3622
3623 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3624 return !ada_is_array_type (type0) || !ada_is_array_type (type1);
3625
3626 case BINOP_EXP:
3627 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
3628
3629 case UNOP_NEG:
3630 case UNOP_PLUS:
3631 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3632 case UNOP_ABS:
3633 return (!numeric_type_p (type0));
3634
3635 }
3636 }
3637 \f
3638 /* Renaming */
3639
3640 /* NOTES:
3641
3642 1. In the following, we assume that a renaming type's name may
3643 have an ___XD suffix. It would be nice if this went away at some
3644 point.
3645 2. We handle both the (old) purely type-based representation of
3646 renamings and the (new) variable-based encoding. At some point,
3647 it is devoutly to be hoped that the former goes away
3648 (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09).
3649 3. Subprogram renamings are not implemented, although the XRS
3650 suffix is recognized (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09). */
3651
3652 /* If SYM encodes a renaming,
3653
3654 <renaming> renames <renamed entity>,
3655
3656 sets *LEN to the length of the renamed entity's name,
3657 *RENAMED_ENTITY to that name (not null-terminated), and *RENAMING_EXPR to
3658 the string describing the subcomponent selected from the renamed
3659 entity. Returns ADA_NOT_RENAMING if SYM does not encode a renaming
3660 (in which case, the values of *RENAMED_ENTITY, *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR
3661 are undefined). Otherwise, returns a value indicating the category
3662 of entity renamed: an object (ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING), exception
3663 (ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING), package (ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING), or
3664 subprogram (ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING). Does no allocation; the
3665 strings returned in *RENAMED_ENTITY and *RENAMING_EXPR should not be
3666 deallocated. The values of RENAMED_ENTITY, LEN, or RENAMING_EXPR
3667 may be NULL, in which case they are not assigned.
3668
3669 [Currently, however, GCC does not generate subprogram renamings.] */
3670
3671 enum ada_renaming_category
3672 ada_parse_renaming (struct symbol *sym,
3673 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
3674 const char **renaming_expr)
3675 {
3676 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
3677 const char *info;
3678 const char *suffix;
3679
3680 if (sym == NULL)
3681 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3682 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
3683 {
3684 default:
3685 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3686 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
3687 return parse_old_style_renaming (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym),
3688 renamed_entity, len, renaming_expr);
3689 case LOC_LOCAL:
3690 case LOC_STATIC:
3691 case LOC_COMPUTED:
3692 case LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT:
3693 info = strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR");
3694 if (info == NULL)
3695 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3696 switch (info[5])
3697 {
3698 case '_':
3699 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
3700 info += 6;
3701 break;
3702 case 'E':
3703 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
3704 info += 7;
3705 break;
3706 case 'P':
3707 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
3708 info += 7;
3709 break;
3710 case 'S':
3711 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
3712 info += 7;
3713 break;
3714 default:
3715 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3716 }
3717 }
3718
3719 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
3720 *renamed_entity = info;
3721 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
3722 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
3723 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3724 if (len != NULL)
3725 *len = strlen (info) - strlen (suffix);
3726 suffix += 5;
3727 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
3728 *renaming_expr = suffix;
3729 return kind;
3730 }
3731
3732 /* Assuming TYPE encodes a renaming according to the old encoding in
3733 exp_dbug.ads, returns details of that renaming in *RENAMED_ENTITY,
3734 *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR, as for ada_parse_renaming, above. Returns
3735 ADA_NOT_RENAMING otherwise. */
3736 static enum ada_renaming_category
3737 parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *type,
3738 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
3739 const char **renaming_expr)
3740 {
3741 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
3742 const char *name;
3743 const char *info;
3744 const char *suffix;
3745
3746 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
3747 || TYPE_NFIELDS (type) != 1)
3748 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3749
3750 name = type_name_no_tag (type);
3751 if (name == NULL)
3752 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3753
3754 name = strstr (name, "___XR");
3755 if (name == NULL)
3756 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3757 switch (name[5])
3758 {
3759 case '\0':
3760 case '_':
3761 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
3762 break;
3763 case 'E':
3764 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
3765 break;
3766 case 'P':
3767 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
3768 break;
3769 case 'S':
3770 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
3771 break;
3772 default:
3773 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3774 }
3775
3776 info = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0);
3777 if (info == NULL)
3778 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3779 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
3780 *renamed_entity = info;
3781 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
3782 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
3783 *renaming_expr = suffix + 5;
3784 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
3785 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3786 if (len != NULL)
3787 *len = suffix - info;
3788 return kind;
3789 }
3790
3791 \f
3792
3793 /* Evaluation: Function Calls */
3794
3795 /* Return an lvalue containing the value VAL. This is the identity on
3796 lvalues, and otherwise has the side-effect of pushing a copy of VAL
3797 on the stack, using and updating *SP as the stack pointer, and
3798 returning an lvalue whose value_address points to the copy. */
3799
3800 static struct value *
3801 ensure_lval (struct value *val, struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR *sp)
3802 {
3803 if (! VALUE_LVAL (val))
3804 {
3805 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (value_type (val)));
3806
3807 /* The following is taken from the structure-return code in
3808 call_function_by_hand. FIXME: Therefore, some refactoring seems
3809 indicated. */
3810 if (gdbarch_inner_than (gdbarch, 1, 2))
3811 {
3812 /* Stack grows downward. Align SP and value_address (val) after
3813 reserving sufficient space. */
3814 *sp -= len;
3815 if (gdbarch_frame_align_p (gdbarch))
3816 *sp = gdbarch_frame_align (gdbarch, *sp);
3817 set_value_address (val, *sp);
3818 }
3819 else
3820 {
3821 /* Stack grows upward. Align the frame, allocate space, and
3822 then again, re-align the frame. */
3823 if (gdbarch_frame_align_p (gdbarch))
3824 *sp = gdbarch_frame_align (gdbarch, *sp);
3825 set_value_address (val, *sp);
3826 *sp += len;
3827 if (gdbarch_frame_align_p (gdbarch))
3828 *sp = gdbarch_frame_align (gdbarch, *sp);
3829 }
3830 VALUE_LVAL (val) = lval_memory;
3831
3832 write_memory (value_address (val), value_contents_raw (val), len);
3833 }
3834
3835 return val;
3836 }
3837
3838 /* Return the value ACTUAL, converted to be an appropriate value for a
3839 formal of type FORMAL_TYPE. Use *SP as a stack pointer for
3840 allocating any necessary descriptors (fat pointers), or copies of
3841 values not residing in memory, updating it as needed. */
3842
3843 struct value *
3844 ada_convert_actual (struct value *actual, struct type *formal_type0,
3845 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR *sp)
3846 {
3847 struct type *actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
3848 struct type *formal_type = ada_check_typedef (formal_type0);
3849 struct type *formal_target =
3850 TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
3851 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (formal_type)) : formal_type;
3852 struct type *actual_target =
3853 TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
3854 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (actual_type)) : actual_type;
3855
3856 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (formal_target)
3857 && TYPE_CODE (actual_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
3858 return make_array_descriptor (formal_type, actual, gdbarch, sp);
3859 else if (TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
3860 || TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3861 {
3862 struct value *result;
3863 if (TYPE_CODE (formal_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3864 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (actual_target))
3865 result = desc_data (actual);
3866 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3867 {
3868 if (VALUE_LVAL (actual) != lval_memory)
3869 {
3870 struct value *val;
3871 actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
3872 val = allocate_value (actual_type);
3873 memcpy ((char *) value_contents_raw (val),
3874 (char *) value_contents (actual),
3875 TYPE_LENGTH (actual_type));
3876 actual = ensure_lval (val, gdbarch, sp);
3877 }
3878 result = value_addr (actual);
3879 }
3880 else
3881 return actual;
3882 return value_cast_pointers (formal_type, result);
3883 }
3884 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3885 return ada_value_ind (actual);
3886
3887 return actual;
3888 }
3889
3890
3891 /* Push a descriptor of type TYPE for array value ARR on the stack at
3892 *SP, updating *SP to reflect the new descriptor. Return either
3893 an lvalue representing the new descriptor, or (if TYPE is a pointer-
3894 to-descriptor type rather than a descriptor type), a struct value *
3895 representing a pointer to this descriptor. */
3896
3897 static struct value *
3898 make_array_descriptor (struct type *type, struct value *arr,
3899 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR *sp)
3900 {
3901 struct type *bounds_type = desc_bounds_type (type);
3902 struct type *desc_type = desc_base_type (type);
3903 struct value *descriptor = allocate_value (desc_type);
3904 struct value *bounds = allocate_value (bounds_type);
3905 int i;
3906
3907 for (i = ada_array_arity (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr))); i > 0; i -= 1)
3908 {
3909 modify_general_field (value_type (bounds),
3910 value_contents_writeable (bounds),
3911 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 0),
3912 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 0),
3913 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 0));
3914 modify_general_field (value_type (bounds),
3915 value_contents_writeable (bounds),
3916 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 1),
3917 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 1),
3918 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 1));
3919 }
3920
3921 bounds = ensure_lval (bounds, gdbarch, sp);
3922
3923 modify_general_field (value_type (descriptor),
3924 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
3925 value_address (ensure_lval (arr, gdbarch, sp)),
3926 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (desc_type),
3927 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (desc_type));
3928
3929 modify_general_field (value_type (descriptor),
3930 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
3931 value_address (bounds),
3932 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (desc_type),
3933 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (desc_type));
3934
3935 descriptor = ensure_lval (descriptor, gdbarch, sp);
3936
3937 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3938 return value_addr (descriptor);
3939 else
3940 return descriptor;
3941 }
3942 \f
3943 /* Dummy definitions for an experimental caching module that is not
3944 * used in the public sources. */
3945
3946 static int
3947 lookup_cached_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum namespace,
3948 struct symbol **sym, struct block **block)
3949 {
3950 return 0;
3951 }
3952
3953 static void
3954 cache_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum namespace, struct symbol *sym,
3955 struct block *block)
3956 {
3957 }
3958 \f
3959 /* Symbol Lookup */
3960
3961 /* Return the result of a standard (literal, C-like) lookup of NAME in
3962 given DOMAIN, visible from lexical block BLOCK. */
3963
3964 static struct symbol *
3965 standard_lookup (const char *name, const struct block *block,
3966 domain_enum domain)
3967 {
3968 struct symbol *sym;
3969
3970 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name, domain, &sym, NULL))
3971 return sym;
3972 sym = lookup_symbol_in_language (name, block, domain, language_c, 0);
3973 cache_symbol (name, domain, sym, block_found);
3974 return sym;
3975 }
3976
3977
3978 /* Non-zero iff there is at least one non-function/non-enumeral symbol
3979 in the symbol fields of SYMS[0..N-1]. We treat enumerals as functions,
3980 since they contend in overloading in the same way. */
3981 static int
3982 is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int n)
3983 {
3984 int i;
3985
3986 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
3987 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC
3988 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
3989 || SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) != LOC_CONST))
3990 return 1;
3991
3992 return 0;
3993 }
3994
3995 /* If true (non-zero), then TYPE0 and TYPE1 represent equivalent
3996 struct types. Otherwise, they may not. */
3997
3998 static int
3999 equiv_types (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
4000 {
4001 if (type0 == type1)
4002 return 1;
4003 if (type0 == NULL || type1 == NULL
4004 || TYPE_CODE (type0) != TYPE_CODE (type1))
4005 return 0;
4006 if ((TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
4007 || TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
4008 && ada_type_name (type0) != NULL && ada_type_name (type1) != NULL
4009 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type0), ada_type_name (type1)) == 0)
4010 return 1;
4011
4012 return 0;
4013 }
4014
4015 /* True iff SYM0 represents the same entity as SYM1, or one that is
4016 no more defined than that of SYM1. */
4017
4018 static int
4019 lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *sym0, struct symbol *sym1)
4020 {
4021 if (sym0 == sym1)
4022 return 1;
4023 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym0) != SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym1)
4024 || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0) != SYMBOL_CLASS (sym1))
4025 return 0;
4026
4027 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0))
4028 {
4029 case LOC_UNDEF:
4030 return 1;
4031 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
4032 {
4033 struct type *type0 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0);
4034 struct type *type1 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1);
4035 char *name0 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym0);
4036 char *name1 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym1);
4037 int len0 = strlen (name0);
4038 return
4039 TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE (type1)
4040 && (equiv_types (type0, type1)
4041 || (len0 < strlen (name1) && strncmp (name0, name1, len0) == 0
4042 && strncmp (name1 + len0, "___XV", 5) == 0));
4043 }
4044 case LOC_CONST:
4045 return SYMBOL_VALUE (sym0) == SYMBOL_VALUE (sym1)
4046 && equiv_types (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0), SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1));
4047 default:
4048 return 0;
4049 }
4050 }
4051
4052 /* Append (SYM,BLOCK,SYMTAB) to the end of the array of struct ada_symbol_info
4053 records in OBSTACKP. Do nothing if SYM is a duplicate. */
4054
4055 static void
4056 add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *obstackp,
4057 struct symbol *sym,
4058 struct block *block)
4059 {
4060 int i;
4061 size_t tmp;
4062 struct ada_symbol_info *prevDefns = defns_collected (obstackp, 0);
4063
4064 /* Do not try to complete stub types, as the debugger is probably
4065 already scanning all symbols matching a certain name at the
4066 time when this function is called. Trying to replace the stub
4067 type by its associated full type will cause us to restart a scan
4068 which may lead to an infinite recursion. Instead, the client
4069 collecting the matching symbols will end up collecting several
4070 matches, with at least one of them complete. It can then filter
4071 out the stub ones if needed. */
4072
4073 for (i = num_defns_collected (obstackp) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
4074 {
4075 if (lesseq_defined_than (sym, prevDefns[i].sym))
4076 return;
4077 else if (lesseq_defined_than (prevDefns[i].sym, sym))
4078 {
4079 prevDefns[i].sym = sym;
4080 prevDefns[i].block = block;
4081 return;
4082 }
4083 }
4084
4085 {
4086 struct ada_symbol_info info;
4087
4088 info.sym = sym;
4089 info.block = block;
4090 obstack_grow (obstackp, &info, sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info));
4091 }
4092 }
4093
4094 /* Number of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in
4095 current vector in *OBSTACKP. */
4096
4097 static int
4098 num_defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp)
4099 {
4100 return obstack_object_size (obstackp) / sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info);
4101 }
4102
4103 /* Vector of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in current
4104 vector in *OBSTACKP. If FINISH, close off the vector and return
4105 its final address. */
4106
4107 static struct ada_symbol_info *
4108 defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp, int finish)
4109 {
4110 if (finish)
4111 return obstack_finish (obstackp);
4112 else
4113 return (struct ada_symbol_info *) obstack_base (obstackp);
4114 }
4115
4116 /* Look, in partial_symtab PST, for symbol NAME in given namespace.
4117 Check the global symbols if GLOBAL, the static symbols if not.
4118 Do wild-card match if WILD. */
4119
4120 static struct partial_symbol *
4121 ada_lookup_partial_symbol (struct partial_symtab *pst, const char *name,
4122 int global, domain_enum namespace, int wild)
4123 {
4124 struct partial_symbol **start;
4125 int name_len = strlen (name);
4126 int length = (global ? pst->n_global_syms : pst->n_static_syms);
4127 int i;
4128
4129 if (length == 0)
4130 {
4131 return (NULL);
4132 }
4133
4134 start = (global ?
4135 pst->objfile->global_psymbols.list + pst->globals_offset :
4136 pst->objfile->static_psymbols.list + pst->statics_offset);
4137
4138 if (wild)
4139 {
4140 for (i = 0; i < length; i += 1)
4141 {
4142 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[i];
4143
4144 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (psym),
4145 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (psym), namespace)
4146 && wild_match (name, name_len, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)))
4147 return psym;
4148 }
4149 return NULL;
4150 }
4151 else
4152 {
4153 if (global)
4154 {
4155 int U;
4156 i = 0;
4157 U = length - 1;
4158 while (U - i > 4)
4159 {
4160 int M = (U + i) >> 1;
4161 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[M];
4162 if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] < name[0])
4163 i = M + 1;
4164 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] > name[0])
4165 U = M - 1;
4166 else if (strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), name) < 0)
4167 i = M + 1;
4168 else
4169 U = M;
4170 }
4171 }
4172 else
4173 i = 0;
4174
4175 while (i < length)
4176 {
4177 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[i];
4178
4179 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (psym),
4180 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (psym), namespace))
4181 {
4182 int cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), name_len);
4183
4184 if (cmp < 0)
4185 {
4186 if (global)
4187 break;
4188 }
4189 else if (cmp == 0
4190 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)
4191 + name_len))
4192 return psym;
4193 }
4194 i += 1;
4195 }
4196
4197 if (global)
4198 {
4199 int U;
4200 i = 0;
4201 U = length - 1;
4202 while (U - i > 4)
4203 {
4204 int M = (U + i) >> 1;
4205 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[M];
4206 if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] < '_')
4207 i = M + 1;
4208 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] > '_')
4209 U = M - 1;
4210 else if (strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), "_ada_") < 0)
4211 i = M + 1;
4212 else
4213 U = M;
4214 }
4215 }
4216 else
4217 i = 0;
4218
4219 while (i < length)
4220 {
4221 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[i];
4222
4223 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (psym),
4224 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (psym), namespace))
4225 {
4226 int cmp;
4227
4228 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0];
4229 if (cmp == 0)
4230 {
4231 cmp = strncmp ("_ada_", SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), 5);
4232 if (cmp == 0)
4233 cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym) + 5,
4234 name_len);
4235 }
4236
4237 if (cmp < 0)
4238 {
4239 if (global)
4240 break;
4241 }
4242 else if (cmp == 0
4243 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)
4244 + name_len + 5))
4245 return psym;
4246 }
4247 i += 1;
4248 }
4249 }
4250 return NULL;
4251 }
4252
4253 /* Return a minimal symbol matching NAME according to Ada decoding
4254 rules. Returns NULL if there is no such minimal symbol. Names
4255 prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__" is
4256 first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
4257
4258 struct minimal_symbol *
4259 ada_lookup_simple_minsym (const char *name)
4260 {
4261 struct objfile *objfile;
4262 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
4263 int wild_match;
4264
4265 if (strncmp (name, "standard__", sizeof ("standard__") - 1) == 0)
4266 {
4267 name += sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
4268 wild_match = 0;
4269 }
4270 else
4271 wild_match = (strstr (name, "__") == NULL);
4272
4273 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
4274 {
4275 if (ada_match_name (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol), name, wild_match)
4276 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msymbol) != mst_solib_trampoline)
4277 return msymbol;
4278 }
4279
4280 return NULL;
4281 }
4282
4283 /* For all subprograms that statically enclose the subprogram of the
4284 selected frame, add symbols matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN
4285 and their blocks to the list of data in OBSTACKP, as for
4286 ada_add_block_symbols (q.v.). If WILD, treat as NAME with a
4287 wildcard prefix. */
4288
4289 static void
4290 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (struct obstack *obstackp,
4291 const char *name, domain_enum namespace,
4292 int wild_match)
4293 {
4294 }
4295
4296 /* True if TYPE is definitely an artificial type supplied to a symbol
4297 for which no debugging information was given in the symbol file. */
4298
4299 static int
4300 is_nondebugging_type (struct type *type)
4301 {
4302 char *name = ada_type_name (type);
4303 return (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "<variable, no debug info>") == 0);
4304 }
4305
4306 /* Remove any non-debugging symbols in SYMS[0 .. NSYMS-1] that definitely
4307 duplicate other symbols in the list (The only case I know of where
4308 this happens is when object files containing stabs-in-ecoff are
4309 linked with files containing ordinary ecoff debugging symbols (or no
4310 debugging symbols)). Modifies SYMS to squeeze out deleted entries.
4311 Returns the number of items in the modified list. */
4312
4313 static int
4314 remove_extra_symbols (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms)
4315 {
4316 int i, j;
4317
4318 i = 0;
4319 while (i < nsyms)
4320 {
4321 int remove = 0;
4322
4323 /* If two symbols have the same name and one of them is a stub type,
4324 the get rid of the stub. */
4325
4326 if (TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym))
4327 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym) != NULL)
4328 {
4329 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j++)
4330 {
4331 if (j != i
4332 && !TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[j].sym))
4333 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym) != NULL
4334 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym),
4335 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym)) == 0)
4336 remove = 1;
4337 }
4338 }
4339
4340 /* Two symbols with the same name, same class and same address
4341 should be identical. */
4342
4343 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym) != NULL
4344 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_STATIC
4345 && is_nondebugging_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)))
4346 {
4347 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4348 {
4349 if (i != j
4350 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym) != NULL
4351 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym),
4352 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym)) == 0
4353 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[j].sym)
4354 && SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[i].sym)
4355 == SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[j].sym))
4356 remove = 1;
4357 }
4358 }
4359
4360 if (remove)
4361 {
4362 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4363 syms[j - 1] = syms[j];
4364 nsyms -= 1;
4365 }
4366
4367 i += 1;
4368 }
4369 return nsyms;
4370 }
4371
4372 /* Given a type that corresponds to a renaming entity, use the type name
4373 to extract the scope (package name or function name, fully qualified,
4374 and following the GNAT encoding convention) where this renaming has been
4375 defined. The string returned needs to be deallocated after use. */
4376
4377 static char *
4378 xget_renaming_scope (struct type *renaming_type)
4379 {
4380 /* The renaming types adhere to the following convention:
4381 <scope>__<rename>___<XR extension>.
4382 So, to extract the scope, we search for the "___XR" extension,
4383 and then backtrack until we find the first "__". */
4384
4385 const char *name = type_name_no_tag (renaming_type);
4386 char *suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
4387 char *last;
4388 int scope_len;
4389 char *scope;
4390
4391 /* Now, backtrack a bit until we find the first "__". Start looking
4392 at suffix - 3, as the <rename> part is at least one character long. */
4393
4394 for (last = suffix - 3; last > name; last--)
4395 if (last[0] == '_' && last[1] == '_')
4396 break;
4397
4398 /* Make a copy of scope and return it. */
4399
4400 scope_len = last - name;
4401 scope = (char *) xmalloc ((scope_len + 1) * sizeof (char));
4402
4403 strncpy (scope, name, scope_len);
4404 scope[scope_len] = '\0';
4405
4406 return scope;
4407 }
4408
4409 /* Return nonzero if NAME corresponds to a package name. */
4410
4411 static int
4412 is_package_name (const char *name)
4413 {
4414 /* Here, We take advantage of the fact that no symbols are generated
4415 for packages, while symbols are generated for each function.
4416 So the condition for NAME represent a package becomes equivalent
4417 to NAME not existing in our list of symbols. There is only one
4418 small complication with library-level functions (see below). */
4419
4420 char *fun_name;
4421
4422 /* If it is a function that has not been defined at library level,
4423 then we should be able to look it up in the symbols. */
4424 if (standard_lookup (name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) != NULL)
4425 return 0;
4426
4427 /* Library-level function names start with "_ada_". See if function
4428 "_ada_" followed by NAME can be found. */
4429
4430 /* Do a quick check that NAME does not contain "__", since library-level
4431 functions names cannot contain "__" in them. */
4432 if (strstr (name, "__") != NULL)
4433 return 0;
4434
4435 fun_name = xstrprintf ("_ada_%s", name);
4436
4437 return (standard_lookup (fun_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) == NULL);
4438 }
4439
4440 /* Return nonzero if SYM corresponds to a renaming entity that is
4441 not visible from FUNCTION_NAME. */
4442
4443 static int
4444 old_renaming_is_invisible (const struct symbol *sym, char *function_name)
4445 {
4446 char *scope;
4447
4448 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF)
4449 return 0;
4450
4451 scope = xget_renaming_scope (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym));
4452
4453 make_cleanup (xfree, scope);
4454
4455 /* If the rename has been defined in a package, then it is visible. */
4456 if (is_package_name (scope))
4457 return 0;
4458
4459 /* Check that the rename is in the current function scope by checking
4460 that its name starts with SCOPE. */
4461
4462 /* If the function name starts with "_ada_", it means that it is
4463 a library-level function. Strip this prefix before doing the
4464 comparison, as the encoding for the renaming does not contain
4465 this prefix. */
4466 if (strncmp (function_name, "_ada_", 5) == 0)
4467 function_name += 5;
4468
4469 return (strncmp (function_name, scope, strlen (scope)) != 0);
4470 }
4471
4472 /* Remove entries from SYMS that corresponds to a renaming entity that
4473 is not visible from the function associated with CURRENT_BLOCK or
4474 that is superfluous due to the presence of more specific renaming
4475 information. Places surviving symbols in the initial entries of
4476 SYMS and returns the number of surviving symbols.
4477
4478 Rationale:
4479 First, in cases where an object renaming is implemented as a
4480 reference variable, GNAT may produce both the actual reference
4481 variable and the renaming encoding. In this case, we discard the
4482 latter.
4483
4484 Second, GNAT emits a type following a specified encoding for each renaming
4485 entity. Unfortunately, STABS currently does not support the definition
4486 of types that are local to a given lexical block, so all renamings types
4487 are emitted at library level. As a consequence, if an application
4488 contains two renaming entities using the same name, and a user tries to
4489 print the value of one of these entities, the result of the ada symbol
4490 lookup will also contain the wrong renaming type.
4491
4492 This function partially covers for this limitation by attempting to
4493 remove from the SYMS list renaming symbols that should be visible
4494 from CURRENT_BLOCK. However, there does not seem be a 100% reliable
4495 method with the current information available. The implementation
4496 below has a couple of limitations (FIXME: brobecker-2003-05-12):
4497
4498 - When the user tries to print a rename in a function while there
4499 is another rename entity defined in a package: Normally, the
4500 rename in the function has precedence over the rename in the
4501 package, so the latter should be removed from the list. This is
4502 currently not the case.
4503
4504 - This function will incorrectly remove valid renames if
4505 the CURRENT_BLOCK corresponds to a function which symbol name
4506 has been changed by an "Export" pragma. As a consequence,
4507 the user will be unable to print such rename entities. */
4508
4509 static int
4510 remove_irrelevant_renamings (struct ada_symbol_info *syms,
4511 int nsyms, const struct block *current_block)
4512 {
4513 struct symbol *current_function;
4514 char *current_function_name;
4515 int i;
4516 int is_new_style_renaming;
4517
4518 /* If there is both a renaming foo___XR... encoded as a variable and
4519 a simple variable foo in the same block, discard the latter.
4520 First, zero out such symbols, then compress. */
4521 is_new_style_renaming = 0;
4522 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
4523 {
4524 struct symbol *sym = syms[i].sym;
4525 struct block *block = syms[i].block;
4526 const char *name;
4527 const char *suffix;
4528
4529 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
4530 continue;
4531 name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym);
4532 suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
4533
4534 if (suffix != NULL)
4535 {
4536 int name_len = suffix - name;
4537 int j;
4538 is_new_style_renaming = 1;
4539 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4540 if (i != j && syms[j].sym != NULL
4541 && strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
4542 name_len) == 0
4543 && block == syms[j].block)
4544 syms[j].sym = NULL;
4545 }
4546 }
4547 if (is_new_style_renaming)
4548 {
4549 int j, k;
4550
4551 for (j = k = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4552 if (syms[j].sym != NULL)
4553 {
4554 syms[k] = syms[j];
4555 k += 1;
4556 }
4557 return k;
4558 }
4559
4560 /* Extract the function name associated to CURRENT_BLOCK.
4561 Abort if unable to do so. */
4562
4563 if (current_block == NULL)
4564 return nsyms;
4565
4566 current_function = block_linkage_function (current_block);
4567 if (current_function == NULL)
4568 return nsyms;
4569
4570 current_function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (current_function);
4571 if (current_function_name == NULL)
4572 return nsyms;
4573
4574 /* Check each of the symbols, and remove it from the list if it is
4575 a type corresponding to a renaming that is out of the scope of
4576 the current block. */
4577
4578 i = 0;
4579 while (i < nsyms)
4580 {
4581 if (ada_parse_renaming (syms[i].sym, NULL, NULL, NULL)
4582 == ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING
4583 && old_renaming_is_invisible (syms[i].sym, current_function_name))
4584 {
4585 int j;
4586 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4587 syms[j - 1] = syms[j];
4588 nsyms -= 1;
4589 }
4590 else
4591 i += 1;
4592 }
4593
4594 return nsyms;
4595 }
4596
4597 /* Add to OBSTACKP all symbols from BLOCK (and its super-blocks)
4598 whose name and domain match NAME and DOMAIN respectively.
4599 If no match was found, then extend the search to "enclosing"
4600 routines (in other words, if we're inside a nested function,
4601 search the symbols defined inside the enclosing functions).
4602
4603 Note: This function assumes that OBSTACKP has 0 (zero) element in it. */
4604
4605 static void
4606 ada_add_local_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name,
4607 struct block *block, domain_enum domain,
4608 int wild_match)
4609 {
4610 int block_depth = 0;
4611
4612 while (block != NULL)
4613 {
4614 block_depth += 1;
4615 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp, block, name, domain, NULL, wild_match);
4616
4617 /* If we found a non-function match, assume that's the one. */
4618 if (is_nonfunction (defns_collected (obstackp, 0),
4619 num_defns_collected (obstackp)))
4620 return;
4621
4622 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
4623 }
4624
4625 /* If no luck so far, try to find NAME as a local symbol in some lexically
4626 enclosing subprogram. */
4627 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && block_depth > 2)
4628 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (obstackp, name, domain, wild_match);
4629 }
4630
4631 /* Add to OBSTACKP all non-local symbols whose name and domain match
4632 NAME and DOMAIN respectively. The search is performed on GLOBAL_BLOCK
4633 symbols if GLOBAL is non-zero, or on STATIC_BLOCK symbols otherwise. */
4634
4635 static void
4636 ada_add_non_local_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name,
4637 domain_enum domain, int global,
4638 int wild_match)
4639 {
4640 struct objfile *objfile;
4641 struct partial_symtab *ps;
4642
4643 ALL_PSYMTABS (objfile, ps)
4644 {
4645 QUIT;
4646 if (ps->readin
4647 || ada_lookup_partial_symbol (ps, name, global, domain, wild_match))
4648 {
4649 struct symtab *s = PSYMTAB_TO_SYMTAB (ps);
4650 const int block_kind = global ? GLOBAL_BLOCK : STATIC_BLOCK;
4651
4652 if (s == NULL || !s->primary)
4653 continue;
4654 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp,
4655 BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), block_kind),
4656 name, domain, objfile, wild_match);
4657 }
4658 }
4659 }
4660
4661 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME0, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
4662 scope and in global scopes, returning the number of matches. Sets
4663 *RESULTS to point to a vector of (SYM,BLOCK) tuples,
4664 indicating the symbols found and the blocks and symbol tables (if
4665 any) in which they were found. This vector are transient---good only to
4666 the next call of ada_lookup_symbol_list. Any non-function/non-enumeral
4667 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK0,
4668 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or
4669 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or
4670 surrounding BLOCK0, then these alone are returned. Otherwise, the
4671 search extends to global and file-scope (static) symbol tables.
4672 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__"
4673 is first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
4674
4675 int
4676 ada_lookup_symbol_list (const char *name0, const struct block *block0,
4677 domain_enum namespace,
4678 struct ada_symbol_info **results)
4679 {
4680 struct symbol *sym;
4681 struct block *block;
4682 const char *name;
4683 int wild_match;
4684 int cacheIfUnique;
4685 int ndefns;
4686
4687 obstack_free (&symbol_list_obstack, NULL);
4688 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
4689
4690 cacheIfUnique = 0;
4691
4692 /* Search specified block and its superiors. */
4693
4694 wild_match = (strstr (name0, "__") == NULL);
4695 name = name0;
4696 block = (struct block *) block0; /* FIXME: No cast ought to be
4697 needed, but adding const will
4698 have a cascade effect. */
4699
4700 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package
4701 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without
4702 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order
4703 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions
4704 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error
4705 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error
4706 entity inside its program). */
4707 if (strncmp (name0, "standard__", sizeof ("standard__") - 1) == 0)
4708 {
4709 wild_match = 0;
4710 block = NULL;
4711 name = name0 + sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
4712 }
4713
4714 /* Check the non-global symbols. If we have ANY match, then we're done. */
4715
4716 ada_add_local_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, block, namespace,
4717 wild_match);
4718 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) > 0)
4719 goto done;
4720
4721 /* No non-global symbols found. Check our cache to see if we have
4722 already performed this search before. If we have, then return
4723 the same result. */
4724
4725 cacheIfUnique = 1;
4726 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name0, namespace, &sym, &block))
4727 {
4728 if (sym != NULL)
4729 add_defn_to_vec (&symbol_list_obstack, sym, block);
4730 goto done;
4731 }
4732
4733 /* Search symbols from all global blocks. */
4734
4735 ada_add_non_local_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, namespace, 1,
4736 wild_match);
4737
4738 /* Now add symbols from all per-file blocks if we've gotten no hits
4739 (not strictly correct, but perhaps better than an error). */
4740
4741 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) == 0)
4742 ada_add_non_local_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, namespace, 0,
4743 wild_match);
4744
4745 done:
4746 ndefns = num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack);
4747 *results = defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack, 1);
4748
4749 ndefns = remove_extra_symbols (*results, ndefns);
4750
4751 if (ndefns == 0)
4752 cache_symbol (name0, namespace, NULL, NULL);
4753
4754 if (ndefns == 1 && cacheIfUnique)
4755 cache_symbol (name0, namespace, (*results)[0].sym, (*results)[0].block);
4756
4757 ndefns = remove_irrelevant_renamings (*results, ndefns, block0);
4758
4759 return ndefns;
4760 }
4761
4762 struct symbol *
4763 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
4764 domain_enum namespace, struct block **block_found)
4765 {
4766 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
4767 int n_candidates;
4768
4769 n_candidates = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, block0, namespace, &candidates);
4770
4771 if (n_candidates == 0)
4772 return NULL;
4773
4774 if (block_found != NULL)
4775 *block_found = candidates[0].block;
4776
4777 return fixup_symbol_section (candidates[0].sym, NULL);
4778 }
4779
4780 /* Return a symbol in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
4781 scope and in global scopes, or NULL if none. NAME is folded and
4782 encoded first. Otherwise, the result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list,
4783 choosing the first symbol if there are multiple choices.
4784 *IS_A_FIELD_OF_THIS is set to 0 and *SYMTAB is set to the symbol
4785 table in which the symbol was found (in both cases, these
4786 assignments occur only if the pointers are non-null). */
4787 struct symbol *
4788 ada_lookup_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
4789 domain_enum namespace, int *is_a_field_of_this)
4790 {
4791 if (is_a_field_of_this != NULL)
4792 *is_a_field_of_this = 0;
4793
4794 return
4795 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (ada_encode (ada_fold_name (name)),
4796 block0, namespace, NULL);
4797 }
4798
4799 static struct symbol *
4800 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal (const char *name,
4801 const char *linkage_name,
4802 const struct block *block,
4803 const domain_enum domain)
4804 {
4805 if (linkage_name == NULL)
4806 linkage_name = name;
4807 return ada_lookup_symbol (linkage_name, block_static_block (block), domain,
4808 NULL);
4809 }
4810
4811
4812 /* True iff STR is a possible encoded suffix of a normal Ada name
4813 that is to be ignored for matching purposes. Suffixes of parallel
4814 names (e.g., XVE) are not included here. Currently, the possible suffixes
4815 are given by any of the regular expressions:
4816
4817 [.$][0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as GNU/Linux]
4818 ___[0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as HP/UX]
4819 _E[0-9]+[bs]$ [protected object entry suffixes]
4820 (X[nb]*)?((\$|__)[0-9](_?[0-9]+)|___(JM|LJM|X([FDBUP].*|R[^T]?)))?$
4821
4822 Also, any leading "__[0-9]+" sequence is skipped before the suffix
4823 match is performed. This sequence is used to differentiate homonyms,
4824 is an optional part of a valid name suffix. */
4825
4826 static int
4827 is_name_suffix (const char *str)
4828 {
4829 int k;
4830 const char *matching;
4831 const int len = strlen (str);
4832
4833 /* Skip optional leading __[0-9]+. */
4834
4835 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && isdigit (str[2]))
4836 {
4837 str += 3;
4838 while (isdigit (str[0]))
4839 str += 1;
4840 }
4841
4842 /* [.$][0-9]+ */
4843
4844 if (str[0] == '.' || str[0] == '$')
4845 {
4846 matching = str + 1;
4847 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
4848 matching += 1;
4849 if (matching[0] == '\0')
4850 return 1;
4851 }
4852
4853 /* ___[0-9]+ */
4854
4855 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && str[2] == '_')
4856 {
4857 matching = str + 3;
4858 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
4859 matching += 1;
4860 if (matching[0] == '\0')
4861 return 1;
4862 }
4863
4864 #if 0
4865 /* FIXME: brobecker/2005-09-23: Protected Object subprograms end
4866 with a N at the end. Unfortunately, the compiler uses the same
4867 convention for other internal types it creates. So treating
4868 all entity names that end with an "N" as a name suffix causes
4869 some regressions. For instance, consider the case of an enumerated
4870 type. To support the 'Image attribute, it creates an array whose
4871 name ends with N.
4872 Having a single character like this as a suffix carrying some
4873 information is a bit risky. Perhaps we should change the encoding
4874 to be something like "_N" instead. In the meantime, do not do
4875 the following check. */
4876 /* Protected Object Subprograms */
4877 if (len == 1 && str [0] == 'N')
4878 return 1;
4879 #endif
4880
4881 /* _E[0-9]+[bs]$ */
4882 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str [1] == 'E' && isdigit (str[2]))
4883 {
4884 matching = str + 3;
4885 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
4886 matching += 1;
4887 if ((matching[0] == 'b' || matching[0] == 's')
4888 && matching [1] == '\0')
4889 return 1;
4890 }
4891
4892 /* ??? We should not modify STR directly, as we are doing below. This
4893 is fine in this case, but may become problematic later if we find
4894 that this alternative did not work, and want to try matching
4895 another one from the begining of STR. Since we modified it, we
4896 won't be able to find the begining of the string anymore! */
4897 if (str[0] == 'X')
4898 {
4899 str += 1;
4900 while (str[0] != '_' && str[0] != '\0')
4901 {
4902 if (str[0] != 'n' && str[0] != 'b')
4903 return 0;
4904 str += 1;
4905 }
4906 }
4907
4908 if (str[0] == '\000')
4909 return 1;
4910
4911 if (str[0] == '_')
4912 {
4913 if (str[1] != '_' || str[2] == '\000')
4914 return 0;
4915 if (str[2] == '_')
4916 {
4917 if (strcmp (str + 3, "JM") == 0)
4918 return 1;
4919 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-09-30: GNAT will soon stop using
4920 the LJM suffix in favor of the JM one. But we will
4921 still accept LJM as a valid suffix for a reasonable
4922 amount of time, just to allow ourselves to debug programs
4923 compiled using an older version of GNAT. */
4924 if (strcmp (str + 3, "LJM") == 0)
4925 return 1;
4926 if (str[3] != 'X')
4927 return 0;
4928 if (str[4] == 'F' || str[4] == 'D' || str[4] == 'B'
4929 || str[4] == 'U' || str[4] == 'P')
4930 return 1;
4931 if (str[4] == 'R' && str[5] != 'T')
4932 return 1;
4933 return 0;
4934 }
4935 if (!isdigit (str[2]))
4936 return 0;
4937 for (k = 3; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
4938 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
4939 return 0;
4940 return 1;
4941 }
4942 if (str[0] == '$' && isdigit (str[1]))
4943 {
4944 for (k = 2; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
4945 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
4946 return 0;
4947 return 1;
4948 }
4949 return 0;
4950 }
4951
4952 /* Return non-zero if the string starting at NAME and ending before
4953 NAME_END contains no capital letters. */
4954
4955 static int
4956 is_valid_name_for_wild_match (const char *name0)
4957 {
4958 const char *decoded_name = ada_decode (name0);
4959 int i;
4960
4961 /* If the decoded name starts with an angle bracket, it means that
4962 NAME0 does not follow the GNAT encoding format. It should then
4963 not be allowed as a possible wild match. */
4964 if (decoded_name[0] == '<')
4965 return 0;
4966
4967 for (i=0; decoded_name[i] != '\0'; i++)
4968 if (isalpha (decoded_name[i]) && !islower (decoded_name[i]))
4969 return 0;
4970
4971 return 1;
4972 }
4973
4974 /* True if NAME represents a name of the form A1.A2....An, n>=1 and
4975 PATN[0..PATN_LEN-1] = Ak.Ak+1.....An for some k >= 1. Ignores
4976 informational suffixes of NAME (i.e., for which is_name_suffix is
4977 true). */
4978
4979 static int
4980 wild_match (const char *patn0, int patn_len, const char *name0)
4981 {
4982 char* match;
4983 const char* start;
4984 start = name0;
4985 while (1)
4986 {
4987 match = strstr (start, patn0);
4988 if (match == NULL)
4989 return 0;
4990 if ((match == name0
4991 || match[-1] == '.'
4992 || (match > name0 + 1 && match[-1] == '_' && match[-2] == '_')
4993 || (match == name0 + 5 && strncmp ("_ada_", name0, 5) == 0))
4994 && is_name_suffix (match + patn_len))
4995 return (match == name0 || is_valid_name_for_wild_match (name0));
4996 start = match + 1;
4997 }
4998 }
4999
5000 /* Add symbols from BLOCK matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN to
5001 vector *defn_symbols, updating the list of symbols in OBSTACKP
5002 (if necessary). If WILD, treat as NAME with a wildcard prefix.
5003 OBJFILE is the section containing BLOCK.
5004 SYMTAB is recorded with each symbol added. */
5005
5006 static void
5007 ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5008 struct block *block, const char *name,
5009 domain_enum domain, struct objfile *objfile,
5010 int wild)
5011 {
5012 struct dict_iterator iter;
5013 int name_len = strlen (name);
5014 /* A matching argument symbol, if any. */
5015 struct symbol *arg_sym;
5016 /* Set true when we find a matching non-argument symbol. */
5017 int found_sym;
5018 struct symbol *sym;
5019
5020 arg_sym = NULL;
5021 found_sym = 0;
5022 if (wild)
5023 {
5024 struct symbol *sym;
5025 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
5026 {
5027 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5028 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain)
5029 && wild_match (name, name_len, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym)))
5030 {
5031 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5032 continue;
5033 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5034 arg_sym = sym;
5035 else
5036 {
5037 found_sym = 1;
5038 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5039 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5040 block);
5041 }
5042 }
5043 }
5044 }
5045 else
5046 {
5047 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
5048 {
5049 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5050 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
5051 {
5052 int cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), name_len);
5053 if (cmp == 0
5054 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + name_len))
5055 {
5056 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5057 {
5058 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5059 arg_sym = sym;
5060 else
5061 {
5062 found_sym = 1;
5063 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5064 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5065 block);
5066 }
5067 }
5068 }
5069 }
5070 }
5071 }
5072
5073 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
5074 {
5075 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5076 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
5077 block);
5078 }
5079
5080 if (!wild)
5081 {
5082 arg_sym = NULL;
5083 found_sym = 0;
5084
5085 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
5086 {
5087 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5088 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
5089 {
5090 int cmp;
5091
5092 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym)[0];
5093 if (cmp == 0)
5094 {
5095 cmp = strncmp ("_ada_", SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), 5);
5096 if (cmp == 0)
5097 cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + 5,
5098 name_len);
5099 }
5100
5101 if (cmp == 0
5102 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + name_len + 5))
5103 {
5104 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5105 {
5106 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5107 arg_sym = sym;
5108 else
5109 {
5110 found_sym = 1;
5111 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5112 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5113 block);
5114 }
5115 }
5116 }
5117 }
5118 }
5119
5120 /* NOTE: This really shouldn't be needed for _ada_ symbols.
5121 They aren't parameters, right? */
5122 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
5123 {
5124 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5125 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
5126 block);
5127 }
5128 }
5129 }
5130 \f
5131
5132 /* Symbol Completion */
5133
5134 /* If SYM_NAME is a completion candidate for TEXT, return this symbol
5135 name in a form that's appropriate for the completion. The result
5136 does not need to be deallocated, but is only good until the next call.
5137
5138 TEXT_LEN is equal to the length of TEXT.
5139 Perform a wild match if WILD_MATCH is set.
5140 ENCODED should be set if TEXT represents the start of a symbol name
5141 in its encoded form. */
5142
5143 static const char *
5144 symbol_completion_match (const char *sym_name,
5145 const char *text, int text_len,
5146 int wild_match, int encoded)
5147 {
5148 char *result;
5149 const int verbatim_match = (text[0] == '<');
5150 int match = 0;
5151
5152 if (verbatim_match)
5153 {
5154 /* Strip the leading angle bracket. */
5155 text = text + 1;
5156 text_len--;
5157 }
5158
5159 /* First, test against the fully qualified name of the symbol. */
5160
5161 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
5162 match = 1;
5163
5164 if (match && !encoded)
5165 {
5166 /* One needed check before declaring a positive match is to verify
5167 that iff we are doing a verbatim match, the decoded version
5168 of the symbol name starts with '<'. Otherwise, this symbol name
5169 is not a suitable completion. */
5170 const char *sym_name_copy = sym_name;
5171 int has_angle_bracket;
5172
5173 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
5174 has_angle_bracket = (sym_name[0] == '<');
5175 match = (has_angle_bracket == verbatim_match);
5176 sym_name = sym_name_copy;
5177 }
5178
5179 if (match && !verbatim_match)
5180 {
5181 /* When doing non-verbatim match, another check that needs to
5182 be done is to verify that the potentially matching symbol name
5183 does not include capital letters, because the ada-mode would
5184 not be able to understand these symbol names without the
5185 angle bracket notation. */
5186 const char *tmp;
5187
5188 for (tmp = sym_name; *tmp != '\0' && !isupper (*tmp); tmp++);
5189 if (*tmp != '\0')
5190 match = 0;
5191 }
5192
5193 /* Second: Try wild matching... */
5194
5195 if (!match && wild_match)
5196 {
5197 /* Since we are doing wild matching, this means that TEXT
5198 may represent an unqualified symbol name. We therefore must
5199 also compare TEXT against the unqualified name of the symbol. */
5200 sym_name = ada_unqualified_name (ada_decode (sym_name));
5201
5202 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
5203 match = 1;
5204 }
5205
5206 /* Finally: If we found a mach, prepare the result to return. */
5207
5208 if (!match)
5209 return NULL;
5210
5211 if (verbatim_match)
5212 sym_name = add_angle_brackets (sym_name);
5213
5214 if (!encoded)
5215 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
5216
5217 return sym_name;
5218 }
5219
5220 typedef char *char_ptr;
5221 DEF_VEC_P (char_ptr);
5222
5223 /* A companion function to ada_make_symbol_completion_list().
5224 Check if SYM_NAME represents a symbol which name would be suitable
5225 to complete TEXT (TEXT_LEN is the length of TEXT), in which case
5226 it is appended at the end of the given string vector SV.
5227
5228 ORIG_TEXT is the string original string from the user command
5229 that needs to be completed. WORD is the entire command on which
5230 completion should be performed. These two parameters are used to
5231 determine which part of the symbol name should be added to the
5232 completion vector.
5233 if WILD_MATCH is set, then wild matching is performed.
5234 ENCODED should be set if TEXT represents a symbol name in its
5235 encoded formed (in which case the completion should also be
5236 encoded). */
5237
5238 static void
5239 symbol_completion_add (VEC(char_ptr) **sv,
5240 const char *sym_name,
5241 const char *text, int text_len,
5242 const char *orig_text, const char *word,
5243 int wild_match, int encoded)
5244 {
5245 const char *match = symbol_completion_match (sym_name, text, text_len,
5246 wild_match, encoded);
5247 char *completion;
5248
5249 if (match == NULL)
5250 return;
5251
5252 /* We found a match, so add the appropriate completion to the given
5253 string vector. */
5254
5255 if (word == orig_text)
5256 {
5257 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
5258 strcpy (completion, match);
5259 }
5260 else if (word > orig_text)
5261 {
5262 /* Return some portion of sym_name. */
5263 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
5264 strcpy (completion, match + (word - orig_text));
5265 }
5266 else
5267 {
5268 /* Return some of ORIG_TEXT plus sym_name. */
5269 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + (orig_text - word) + 5);
5270 strncpy (completion, word, orig_text - word);
5271 completion[orig_text - word] = '\0';
5272 strcat (completion, match);
5273 }
5274
5275 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, *sv, completion);
5276 }
5277
5278 /* Return a list of possible symbol names completing TEXT0. The list
5279 is NULL terminated. WORD is the entire command on which completion
5280 is made. */
5281
5282 static char **
5283 ada_make_symbol_completion_list (char *text0, char *word)
5284 {
5285 char *text;
5286 int text_len;
5287 int wild_match;
5288 int encoded;
5289 VEC(char_ptr) *completions = VEC_alloc (char_ptr, 128);
5290 struct symbol *sym;
5291 struct symtab *s;
5292 struct partial_symtab *ps;
5293 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
5294 struct objfile *objfile;
5295 struct block *b, *surrounding_static_block = 0;
5296 int i;
5297 struct dict_iterator iter;
5298
5299 if (text0[0] == '<')
5300 {
5301 text = xstrdup (text0);
5302 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
5303 text_len = strlen (text);
5304 wild_match = 0;
5305 encoded = 1;
5306 }
5307 else
5308 {
5309 text = xstrdup (ada_encode (text0));
5310 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
5311 text_len = strlen (text);
5312 for (i = 0; i < text_len; i++)
5313 text[i] = tolower (text[i]);
5314
5315 encoded = (strstr (text0, "__") != NULL);
5316 /* If the name contains a ".", then the user is entering a fully
5317 qualified entity name, and the match must not be done in wild
5318 mode. Similarly, if the user wants to complete what looks like
5319 an encoded name, the match must not be done in wild mode. */
5320 wild_match = (strchr (text0, '.') == NULL && !encoded);
5321 }
5322
5323 /* First, look at the partial symtab symbols. */
5324 ALL_PSYMTABS (objfile, ps)
5325 {
5326 struct partial_symbol **psym;
5327
5328 /* If the psymtab's been read in we'll get it when we search
5329 through the blockvector. */
5330 if (ps->readin)
5331 continue;
5332
5333 for (psym = objfile->global_psymbols.list + ps->globals_offset;
5334 psym < (objfile->global_psymbols.list + ps->globals_offset
5335 + ps->n_global_syms); psym++)
5336 {
5337 QUIT;
5338 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (*psym),
5339 text, text_len, text0, word,
5340 wild_match, encoded);
5341 }
5342
5343 for (psym = objfile->static_psymbols.list + ps->statics_offset;
5344 psym < (objfile->static_psymbols.list + ps->statics_offset
5345 + ps->n_static_syms); psym++)
5346 {
5347 QUIT;
5348 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (*psym),
5349 text, text_len, text0, word,
5350 wild_match, encoded);
5351 }
5352 }
5353
5354 /* At this point scan through the misc symbol vectors and add each
5355 symbol you find to the list. Eventually we want to ignore
5356 anything that isn't a text symbol (everything else will be
5357 handled by the psymtab code above). */
5358
5359 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
5360 {
5361 QUIT;
5362 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol),
5363 text, text_len, text0, word, wild_match, encoded);
5364 }
5365
5366 /* Search upwards from currently selected frame (so that we can
5367 complete on local vars. */
5368
5369 for (b = get_selected_block (0); b != NULL; b = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
5370 {
5371 if (!BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
5372 surrounding_static_block = b; /* For elmin of dups */
5373
5374 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5375 {
5376 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5377 text, text_len, text0, word,
5378 wild_match, encoded);
5379 }
5380 }
5381
5382 /* Go through the symtabs and check the externs and statics for
5383 symbols which match. */
5384
5385 ALL_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
5386 {
5387 QUIT;
5388 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
5389 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5390 {
5391 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5392 text, text_len, text0, word,
5393 wild_match, encoded);
5394 }
5395 }
5396
5397 ALL_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
5398 {
5399 QUIT;
5400 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), STATIC_BLOCK);
5401 /* Don't do this block twice. */
5402 if (b == surrounding_static_block)
5403 continue;
5404 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5405 {
5406 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5407 text, text_len, text0, word,
5408 wild_match, encoded);
5409 }
5410 }
5411
5412 /* Append the closing NULL entry. */
5413 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, completions, NULL);
5414
5415 /* Make a copy of the COMPLETIONS VEC before we free it, and then
5416 return the copy. It's unfortunate that we have to make a copy
5417 of an array that we're about to destroy, but there is nothing much
5418 we can do about it. Fortunately, it's typically not a very large
5419 array. */
5420 {
5421 const size_t completions_size =
5422 VEC_length (char_ptr, completions) * sizeof (char *);
5423 char **result = malloc (completions_size);
5424
5425 memcpy (result, VEC_address (char_ptr, completions), completions_size);
5426
5427 VEC_free (char_ptr, completions);
5428 return result;
5429 }
5430 }
5431
5432 /* Field Access */
5433
5434 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is a pointer to the GNAT dispatch table used
5435 for tagged types. */
5436
5437 static int
5438 ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (struct type *type)
5439 {
5440 char *name;
5441
5442 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5443 return 0;
5444
5445 name = TYPE_NAME (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
5446 if (name == NULL)
5447 return 0;
5448
5449 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
5450 }
5451
5452 /* True if field number FIELD_NUM in struct or union type TYPE is supposed
5453 to be invisible to users. */
5454
5455 int
5456 ada_is_ignored_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
5457 {
5458 if (field_num < 0 || field_num > TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
5459 return 1;
5460
5461 /* Check the name of that field. */
5462 {
5463 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5464
5465 /* Anonymous field names should not be printed.
5466 brobecker/2007-02-20: I don't think this can actually happen
5467 but we don't want to print the value of annonymous fields anyway. */
5468 if (name == NULL)
5469 return 1;
5470
5471 /* A field named "_parent" is internally generated by GNAT for
5472 tagged types, and should not be printed either. */
5473 if (name[0] == '_' && strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) != 0)
5474 return 1;
5475 }
5476
5477 /* If this is the dispatch table of a tagged type, then ignore. */
5478 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 1)
5479 && ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num)))
5480 return 1;
5481
5482 /* Not a special field, so it should not be ignored. */
5483 return 0;
5484 }
5485
5486 /* True iff TYPE has a tag field. If REFOK, then TYPE may also be a
5487 pointer or reference type whose ultimate target has a tag field. */
5488
5489 int
5490 ada_is_tagged_type (struct type *type, int refok)
5491 {
5492 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "_tag", refok, 1, NULL) != NULL);
5493 }
5494
5495 /* True iff TYPE represents the type of X'Tag */
5496
5497 int
5498 ada_is_tag_type (struct type *type)
5499 {
5500 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5501 return 0;
5502 else
5503 {
5504 const char *name = ada_type_name (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
5505 return (name != NULL
5506 && strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
5507 }
5508 }
5509
5510 /* The type of the tag on VAL. */
5511
5512 struct type *
5513 ada_tag_type (struct value *val)
5514 {
5515 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (value_type (val), "_tag", 1, 0, NULL);
5516 }
5517
5518 /* The value of the tag on VAL. */
5519
5520 struct value *
5521 ada_value_tag (struct value *val)
5522 {
5523 return ada_value_struct_elt (val, "_tag", 0);
5524 }
5525
5526 /* The value of the tag on the object of type TYPE whose contents are
5527 saved at VALADDR, if it is non-null, or is at memory address
5528 ADDRESS. */
5529
5530 static struct value *
5531 value_tag_from_contents_and_address (struct type *type,
5532 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
5533 CORE_ADDR address)
5534 {
5535 int tag_byte_offset, dummy1, dummy2;
5536 struct type *tag_type;
5537 if (find_struct_field ("_tag", type, 0, &tag_type, &tag_byte_offset,
5538 NULL, NULL, NULL))
5539 {
5540 const gdb_byte *valaddr1 = ((valaddr == NULL)
5541 ? NULL
5542 : valaddr + tag_byte_offset);
5543 CORE_ADDR address1 = (address == 0) ? 0 : address + tag_byte_offset;
5544
5545 return value_from_contents_and_address (tag_type, valaddr1, address1);
5546 }
5547 return NULL;
5548 }
5549
5550 static struct type *
5551 type_from_tag (struct value *tag)
5552 {
5553 const char *type_name = ada_tag_name (tag);
5554 if (type_name != NULL)
5555 return ada_find_any_type (ada_encode (type_name));
5556 return NULL;
5557 }
5558
5559 struct tag_args
5560 {
5561 struct value *tag;
5562 char *name;
5563 };
5564
5565
5566 static int ada_tag_name_1 (void *);
5567 static int ada_tag_name_2 (struct tag_args *);
5568
5569 /* Wrapper function used by ada_tag_name. Given a struct tag_args*
5570 value ARGS, sets ARGS->name to the tag name of ARGS->tag.
5571 The value stored in ARGS->name is valid until the next call to
5572 ada_tag_name_1. */
5573
5574 static int
5575 ada_tag_name_1 (void *args0)
5576 {
5577 struct tag_args *args = (struct tag_args *) args0;
5578 static char name[1024];
5579 char *p;
5580 struct value *val;
5581 args->name = NULL;
5582 val = ada_value_struct_elt (args->tag, "tsd", 1);
5583 if (val == NULL)
5584 return ada_tag_name_2 (args);
5585 val = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "expanded_name", 1);
5586 if (val == NULL)
5587 return 0;
5588 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
5589 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
5590 if (isalpha (*p))
5591 *p = tolower (*p);
5592 args->name = name;
5593 return 0;
5594 }
5595
5596 /* Utility function for ada_tag_name_1 that tries the second
5597 representation for the dispatch table (in which there is no
5598 explicit 'tsd' field in the referent of the tag pointer, and instead
5599 the tsd pointer is stored just before the dispatch table. */
5600
5601 static int
5602 ada_tag_name_2 (struct tag_args *args)
5603 {
5604 struct type *info_type;
5605 static char name[1024];
5606 char *p;
5607 struct value *val, *valp;
5608
5609 args->name = NULL;
5610 info_type = ada_find_any_type ("ada__tags__type_specific_data");
5611 if (info_type == NULL)
5612 return 0;
5613 info_type = lookup_pointer_type (lookup_pointer_type (info_type));
5614 valp = value_cast (info_type, args->tag);
5615 if (valp == NULL)
5616 return 0;
5617 val = value_ind (value_ptradd (valp, -1));
5618 if (val == NULL)
5619 return 0;
5620 val = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "expanded_name", 1);
5621 if (val == NULL)
5622 return 0;
5623 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
5624 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
5625 if (isalpha (*p))
5626 *p = tolower (*p);
5627 args->name = name;
5628 return 0;
5629 }
5630
5631 /* The type name of the dynamic type denoted by the 'tag value TAG, as
5632 * a C string. */
5633
5634 const char *
5635 ada_tag_name (struct value *tag)
5636 {
5637 struct tag_args args;
5638 if (!ada_is_tag_type (value_type (tag)))
5639 return NULL;
5640 args.tag = tag;
5641 args.name = NULL;
5642 catch_errors (ada_tag_name_1, &args, NULL, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
5643 return args.name;
5644 }
5645
5646 /* The parent type of TYPE, or NULL if none. */
5647
5648 struct type *
5649 ada_parent_type (struct type *type)
5650 {
5651 int i;
5652
5653 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
5654
5655 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
5656 return NULL;
5657
5658 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
5659 if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
5660 {
5661 struct type *parent_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
5662
5663 /* If the _parent field is a pointer, then dereference it. */
5664 if (TYPE_CODE (parent_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5665 parent_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (parent_type);
5666 /* If there is a parallel XVS type, get the actual base type. */
5667 parent_type = ada_get_base_type (parent_type);
5668
5669 return ada_check_typedef (parent_type);
5670 }
5671
5672 return NULL;
5673 }
5674
5675 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE contains the
5676 parent-type (inherited) fields of a derived type. Assumes TYPE is
5677 a structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
5678
5679 int
5680 ada_is_parent_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
5681 {
5682 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (ada_check_typedef (type), field_num);
5683 return (name != NULL
5684 && (strncmp (name, "PARENT", 6) == 0
5685 || strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) == 0));
5686 }
5687
5688 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE is a
5689 transparent wrapper field (which should be silently traversed when doing
5690 field selection and flattened when printing). Assumes TYPE is a
5691 structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. Such fields are always
5692 structures. */
5693
5694 int
5695 ada_is_wrapper_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
5696 {
5697 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5698 return (name != NULL
5699 && (strncmp (name, "PARENT", 6) == 0
5700 || strcmp (name, "REP") == 0
5701 || strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) == 0
5702 || name[0] == 'S' || name[0] == 'R' || name[0] == 'O'));
5703 }
5704
5705 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure or union type TYPE
5706 is a variant wrapper. Assumes TYPE is a structure type with at least
5707 FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
5708
5709 int
5710 ada_is_variant_part (struct type *type, int field_num)
5711 {
5712 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num);
5713 return (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNION
5714 || (is_dynamic_field (type, field_num)
5715 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type))
5716 == TYPE_CODE_UNION)));
5717 }
5718
5719 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is a variant wrapper (type of the variant part)
5720 whose discriminants are contained in the record type OUTER_TYPE,
5721 returns the type of the controlling discriminant for the variant.
5722 May return NULL if the type could not be found. */
5723
5724 struct type *
5725 ada_variant_discrim_type (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
5726 {
5727 char *name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
5728 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, name, 1, 1, NULL);
5729 }
5730
5731 /* Assuming that TYPE is the type of a variant wrapper, and FIELD_NUM is a
5732 valid field number within it, returns 1 iff field FIELD_NUM of TYPE
5733 represents a 'when others' clause; otherwise 0. */
5734
5735 int
5736 ada_is_others_clause (struct type *type, int field_num)
5737 {
5738 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5739 return (name != NULL && name[0] == 'O');
5740 }
5741
5742 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is the type of the variant part of a record,
5743 returns the name of the discriminant controlling the variant.
5744 The value is valid until the next call to ada_variant_discrim_name. */
5745
5746 char *
5747 ada_variant_discrim_name (struct type *type0)
5748 {
5749 static char *result = NULL;
5750 static size_t result_len = 0;
5751 struct type *type;
5752 const char *name;
5753 const char *discrim_end;
5754 const char *discrim_start;
5755
5756 if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5757 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
5758 else
5759 type = type0;
5760
5761 name = ada_type_name (type);
5762
5763 if (name == NULL || name[0] == '\000')
5764 return "";
5765
5766 for (discrim_end = name + strlen (name) - 6; discrim_end != name;
5767 discrim_end -= 1)
5768 {
5769 if (strncmp (discrim_end, "___XVN", 6) == 0)
5770 break;
5771 }
5772 if (discrim_end == name)
5773 return "";
5774
5775 for (discrim_start = discrim_end; discrim_start != name + 3;
5776 discrim_start -= 1)
5777 {
5778 if (discrim_start == name + 1)
5779 return "";
5780 if ((discrim_start > name + 3
5781 && strncmp (discrim_start - 3, "___", 3) == 0)
5782 || discrim_start[-1] == '.')
5783 break;
5784 }
5785
5786 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, discrim_end - discrim_start + 1);
5787 strncpy (result, discrim_start, discrim_end - discrim_start);
5788 result[discrim_end - discrim_start] = '\0';
5789 return result;
5790 }
5791
5792 /* Scan STR for a subtype-encoded number, beginning at position K.
5793 Put the position of the character just past the number scanned in
5794 *NEW_K, if NEW_K!=NULL. Put the scanned number in *R, if R!=NULL.
5795 Return 1 if there was a valid number at the given position, and 0
5796 otherwise. A "subtype-encoded" number consists of the absolute value
5797 in decimal, followed by the letter 'm' to indicate a negative number.
5798 Assumes 0m does not occur. */
5799
5800 int
5801 ada_scan_number (const char str[], int k, LONGEST * R, int *new_k)
5802 {
5803 ULONGEST RU;
5804
5805 if (!isdigit (str[k]))
5806 return 0;
5807
5808 /* Do it the hard way so as not to make any assumption about
5809 the relationship of unsigned long (%lu scan format code) and
5810 LONGEST. */
5811 RU = 0;
5812 while (isdigit (str[k]))
5813 {
5814 RU = RU * 10 + (str[k] - '0');
5815 k += 1;
5816 }
5817
5818 if (str[k] == 'm')
5819 {
5820 if (R != NULL)
5821 *R = (-(LONGEST) (RU - 1)) - 1;
5822 k += 1;
5823 }
5824 else if (R != NULL)
5825 *R = (LONGEST) RU;
5826
5827 /* NOTE on the above: Technically, C does not say what the results of
5828 - (LONGEST) RU or (LONGEST) -RU are for RU == largest positive
5829 number representable as a LONGEST (although either would probably work
5830 in most implementations). When RU>0, the locution in the then branch
5831 above is always equivalent to the negative of RU. */
5832
5833 if (new_k != NULL)
5834 *new_k = k;
5835 return 1;
5836 }
5837
5838 /* Assuming that TYPE is a variant part wrapper type (a VARIANTS field),
5839 and FIELD_NUM is a valid field number within it, returns 1 iff VAL is
5840 in the range encoded by field FIELD_NUM of TYPE; otherwise 0. */
5841
5842 int
5843 ada_in_variant (LONGEST val, struct type *type, int field_num)
5844 {
5845 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5846 int p;
5847
5848 p = 0;
5849 while (1)
5850 {
5851 switch (name[p])
5852 {
5853 case '\0':
5854 return 0;
5855 case 'S':
5856 {
5857 LONGEST W;
5858 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &W, &p))
5859 return 0;
5860 if (val == W)
5861 return 1;
5862 break;
5863 }
5864 case 'R':
5865 {
5866 LONGEST L, U;
5867 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &L, &p)
5868 || name[p] != 'T' || !ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &U, &p))
5869 return 0;
5870 if (val >= L && val <= U)
5871 return 1;
5872 break;
5873 }
5874 case 'O':
5875 return 1;
5876 default:
5877 return 0;
5878 }
5879 }
5880 }
5881
5882 /* FIXME: Lots of redundancy below. Try to consolidate. */
5883
5884 /* Given a value ARG1 (offset by OFFSET bytes) of a struct or union type
5885 ARG_TYPE, extract and return the value of one of its (non-static)
5886 fields. FIELDNO says which field. Differs from value_primitive_field
5887 only in that it can handle packed values of arbitrary type. */
5888
5889 static struct value *
5890 ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *arg1, int offset, int fieldno,
5891 struct type *arg_type)
5892 {
5893 struct type *type;
5894
5895 arg_type = ada_check_typedef (arg_type);
5896 type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (arg_type, fieldno);
5897
5898 /* Handle packed fields. */
5899
5900 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno) != 0)
5901 {
5902 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (arg_type, fieldno);
5903 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno);
5904
5905 return ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg1, value_contents (arg1),
5906 offset + bit_pos / 8,
5907 bit_pos % 8, bit_size, type);
5908 }
5909 else
5910 return value_primitive_field (arg1, offset, fieldno, arg_type);
5911 }
5912
5913 /* Find field with name NAME in object of type TYPE. If found,
5914 set the following for each argument that is non-null:
5915 - *FIELD_TYPE_P to the field's type;
5916 - *BYTE_OFFSET_P to OFFSET + the byte offset of the field within
5917 an object of that type;
5918 - *BIT_OFFSET_P to the bit offset modulo byte size of the field;
5919 - *BIT_SIZE_P to its size in bits if the field is packed, and
5920 0 otherwise;
5921 If INDEX_P is non-null, increment *INDEX_P by the number of source-visible
5922 fields up to but not including the desired field, or by the total
5923 number of fields if not found. A NULL value of NAME never
5924 matches; the function just counts visible fields in this case.
5925
5926 Returns 1 if found, 0 otherwise. */
5927
5928 static int
5929 find_struct_field (char *name, struct type *type, int offset,
5930 struct type **field_type_p,
5931 int *byte_offset_p, int *bit_offset_p, int *bit_size_p,
5932 int *index_p)
5933 {
5934 int i;
5935
5936 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
5937
5938 if (field_type_p != NULL)
5939 *field_type_p = NULL;
5940 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
5941 *byte_offset_p = 0;
5942 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
5943 *bit_offset_p = 0;
5944 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
5945 *bit_size_p = 0;
5946
5947 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
5948 {
5949 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i);
5950 int fld_offset = offset + bit_pos / 8;
5951 char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
5952
5953 if (t_field_name == NULL)
5954 continue;
5955
5956 else if (name != NULL && field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
5957 {
5958 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, i);
5959 if (field_type_p != NULL)
5960 *field_type_p = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
5961 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
5962 *byte_offset_p = fld_offset;
5963 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
5964 *bit_offset_p = bit_pos % 8;
5965 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
5966 *bit_size_p = bit_size;
5967 return 1;
5968 }
5969 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
5970 {
5971 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), fld_offset,
5972 field_type_p, byte_offset_p, bit_offset_p,
5973 bit_size_p, index_p))
5974 return 1;
5975 }
5976 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
5977 {
5978 /* PNH: Wait. Do we ever execute this section, or is ARG always of
5979 fixed type?? */
5980 int j;
5981 struct type *field_type
5982 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
5983
5984 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
5985 {
5986 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j),
5987 fld_offset
5988 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
5989 field_type_p, byte_offset_p,
5990 bit_offset_p, bit_size_p, index_p))
5991 return 1;
5992 }
5993 }
5994 else if (index_p != NULL)
5995 *index_p += 1;
5996 }
5997 return 0;
5998 }
5999
6000 /* Number of user-visible fields in record type TYPE. */
6001
6002 static int
6003 num_visible_fields (struct type *type)
6004 {
6005 int n;
6006 n = 0;
6007 find_struct_field (NULL, type, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &n);
6008 return n;
6009 }
6010
6011 /* Look for a field NAME in ARG. Adjust the address of ARG by OFFSET bytes,
6012 and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
6013 If found, return value, else return NULL.
6014
6015 Searches recursively through wrapper fields (e.g., '_parent'). */
6016
6017 static struct value *
6018 ada_search_struct_field (char *name, struct value *arg, int offset,
6019 struct type *type)
6020 {
6021 int i;
6022 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6023
6024 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6025 {
6026 char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6027
6028 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6029 continue;
6030
6031 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6032 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
6033
6034 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6035 {
6036 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
6037 ada_search_struct_field (name, arg,
6038 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
6039 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6040 if (v != NULL)
6041 return v;
6042 }
6043
6044 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6045 {
6046 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See find_struct_field. */
6047 int j;
6048 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6049 int var_offset = offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6050
6051 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
6052 {
6053 struct value *v = ada_search_struct_field /* Force line break. */
6054 (name, arg,
6055 var_offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
6056 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
6057 if (v != NULL)
6058 return v;
6059 }
6060 }
6061 }
6062 return NULL;
6063 }
6064
6065 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *, struct value *,
6066 int, struct type *);
6067
6068
6069 /* Return field #INDEX in ARG, where the index is that returned by
6070 * find_struct_field through its INDEX_P argument. Adjust the address
6071 * of ARG by OFFSET bytes, and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
6072 * If found, return value, else return NULL. */
6073
6074 static struct value *
6075 ada_index_struct_field (int index, struct value *arg, int offset,
6076 struct type *type)
6077 {
6078 return ada_index_struct_field_1 (&index, arg, offset, type);
6079 }
6080
6081
6082 /* Auxiliary function for ada_index_struct_field. Like
6083 * ada_index_struct_field, but takes index from *INDEX_P and modifies
6084 * *INDEX_P. */
6085
6086 static struct value *
6087 ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *index_p, struct value *arg, int offset,
6088 struct type *type)
6089 {
6090 int i;
6091 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6092
6093 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6094 {
6095 if (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i) == NULL)
6096 continue;
6097 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6098 {
6099 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
6100 ada_index_struct_field_1 (index_p, arg,
6101 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
6102 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6103 if (v != NULL)
6104 return v;
6105 }
6106
6107 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6108 {
6109 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See ada_search_struct_field,
6110 find_struct_field. */
6111 error (_("Cannot assign this kind of variant record"));
6112 }
6113 else if (*index_p == 0)
6114 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
6115 else
6116 *index_p -= 1;
6117 }
6118 return NULL;
6119 }
6120
6121 /* Given ARG, a value of type (pointer or reference to a)*
6122 structure/union, extract the component named NAME from the ultimate
6123 target structure/union and return it as a value with its
6124 appropriate type.
6125
6126 The routine searches for NAME among all members of the structure itself
6127 and (recursively) among all members of any wrapper members
6128 (e.g., '_parent').
6129
6130 If NO_ERR, then simply return NULL in case of error, rather than
6131 calling error. */
6132
6133 struct value *
6134 ada_value_struct_elt (struct value *arg, char *name, int no_err)
6135 {
6136 struct type *t, *t1;
6137 struct value *v;
6138
6139 v = NULL;
6140 t1 = t = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg));
6141 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6142 {
6143 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
6144 if (t1 == NULL)
6145 goto BadValue;
6146 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
6147 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6148 {
6149 arg = coerce_ref (arg);
6150 t = t1;
6151 }
6152 }
6153
6154 while (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6155 {
6156 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
6157 if (t1 == NULL)
6158 goto BadValue;
6159 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
6160 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6161 {
6162 arg = value_ind (arg);
6163 t = t1;
6164 }
6165 else
6166 break;
6167 }
6168
6169 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT && TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_UNION)
6170 goto BadValue;
6171
6172 if (t1 == t)
6173 v = ada_search_struct_field (name, arg, 0, t);
6174 else
6175 {
6176 int bit_offset, bit_size, byte_offset;
6177 struct type *field_type;
6178 CORE_ADDR address;
6179
6180 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6181 address = value_as_address (arg);
6182 else
6183 address = unpack_pointer (t, value_contents (arg));
6184
6185 t1 = ada_to_fixed_type (ada_get_base_type (t1), NULL, address, NULL, 1);
6186 if (find_struct_field (name, t1, 0,
6187 &field_type, &byte_offset, &bit_offset,
6188 &bit_size, NULL))
6189 {
6190 if (bit_size != 0)
6191 {
6192 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6193 arg = ada_coerce_ref (arg);
6194 else
6195 arg = ada_value_ind (arg);
6196 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg, NULL, byte_offset,
6197 bit_offset, bit_size,
6198 field_type);
6199 }
6200 else
6201 v = value_at_lazy (field_type, address + byte_offset);
6202 }
6203 }
6204
6205 if (v != NULL || no_err)
6206 return v;
6207 else
6208 error (_("There is no member named %s."), name);
6209
6210 BadValue:
6211 if (no_err)
6212 return NULL;
6213 else
6214 error (_("Attempt to extract a component of a value that is not a record."));
6215 }
6216
6217 /* Given a type TYPE, look up the type of the component of type named NAME.
6218 If DISPP is non-null, add its byte displacement from the beginning of a
6219 structure (pointed to by a value) of type TYPE to *DISPP (does not
6220 work for packed fields).
6221
6222 Matches any field whose name has NAME as a prefix, possibly
6223 followed by "___".
6224
6225 TYPE can be either a struct or union. If REFOK, TYPE may also
6226 be a (pointer or reference)+ to a struct or union, and the
6227 ultimate target type will be searched.
6228
6229 Looks recursively into variant clauses and parent types.
6230
6231 If NOERR is nonzero, return NULL if NAME is not suitably defined or
6232 TYPE is not a type of the right kind. */
6233
6234 static struct type *
6235 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *type, char *name, int refok,
6236 int noerr, int *dispp)
6237 {
6238 int i;
6239
6240 if (name == NULL)
6241 goto BadName;
6242
6243 if (refok && type != NULL)
6244 while (1)
6245 {
6246 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6247 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
6248 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
6249 break;
6250 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
6251 }
6252
6253 if (type == NULL
6254 || (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
6255 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_UNION))
6256 {
6257 if (noerr)
6258 return NULL;
6259 else
6260 {
6261 target_terminal_ours ();
6262 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
6263 if (type == NULL)
6264 error (_("Type (null) is not a structure or union type"));
6265 else
6266 {
6267 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6268 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6269 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6270 error (_(" is not a structure or union type"));
6271 }
6272 }
6273 }
6274
6275 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
6276
6277 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6278 {
6279 char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6280 struct type *t;
6281 int disp;
6282
6283 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6284 continue;
6285
6286 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6287 {
6288 if (dispp != NULL)
6289 *dispp += TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6290 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6291 }
6292
6293 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6294 {
6295 disp = 0;
6296 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), name,
6297 0, 1, &disp);
6298 if (t != NULL)
6299 {
6300 if (dispp != NULL)
6301 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6302 return t;
6303 }
6304 }
6305
6306 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6307 {
6308 int j;
6309 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6310
6311 for (j = TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type) - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
6312 {
6313 /* FIXME pnh 2008/01/26: We check for a field that is
6314 NOT wrapped in a struct, since the compiler sometimes
6315 generates these for unchecked variant types. Revisit
6316 if the compiler changes this practice. */
6317 char *v_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (field_type, j);
6318 disp = 0;
6319 if (v_field_name != NULL
6320 && field_name_match (v_field_name, name))
6321 t = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
6322 else
6323 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j),
6324 name, 0, 1, &disp);
6325
6326 if (t != NULL)
6327 {
6328 if (dispp != NULL)
6329 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6330 return t;
6331 }
6332 }
6333 }
6334
6335 }
6336
6337 BadName:
6338 if (!noerr)
6339 {
6340 target_terminal_ours ();
6341 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
6342 if (name == NULL)
6343 {
6344 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6345 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6346 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6347 error (_(" has no component named <null>"));
6348 }
6349 else
6350 {
6351 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6352 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6353 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6354 error (_(" has no component named %s"), name);
6355 }
6356 }
6357
6358 return NULL;
6359 }
6360
6361 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
6362 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE, return true iff VAR_TYPE
6363 represents an unchecked union (that is, the variant part of a
6364 record that is named in an Unchecked_Union pragma). */
6365
6366 static int
6367 is_unchecked_variant (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
6368 {
6369 char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6370 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, discrim_name, 0, 1, NULL)
6371 == NULL);
6372 }
6373
6374
6375 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
6376 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE that is stored in GDB at
6377 OUTER_VALADDR, determine which variant clause (field number in VAR_TYPE,
6378 numbering from 0) is applicable. Returns -1 if none are. */
6379
6380 int
6381 ada_which_variant_applies (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type,
6382 const gdb_byte *outer_valaddr)
6383 {
6384 int others_clause;
6385 int i;
6386 char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6387 struct value *outer;
6388 struct value *discrim;
6389 LONGEST discrim_val;
6390
6391 outer = value_from_contents_and_address (outer_type, outer_valaddr, 0);
6392 discrim = ada_value_struct_elt (outer, discrim_name, 1);
6393 if (discrim == NULL)
6394 return -1;
6395 discrim_val = value_as_long (discrim);
6396
6397 others_clause = -1;
6398 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (var_type); i += 1)
6399 {
6400 if (ada_is_others_clause (var_type, i))
6401 others_clause = i;
6402 else if (ada_in_variant (discrim_val, var_type, i))
6403 return i;
6404 }
6405
6406 return others_clause;
6407 }
6408 \f
6409
6410
6411 /* Dynamic-Sized Records */
6412
6413 /* Strategy: The type ostensibly attached to a value with dynamic size
6414 (i.e., a size that is not statically recorded in the debugging
6415 data) does not accurately reflect the size or layout of the value.
6416 Our strategy is to convert these values to values with accurate,
6417 conventional types that are constructed on the fly. */
6418
6419 /* There is a subtle and tricky problem here. In general, we cannot
6420 determine the size of dynamic records without its data. However,
6421 the 'struct value' data structure, which GDB uses to represent
6422 quantities in the inferior process (the target), requires the size
6423 of the type at the time of its allocation in order to reserve space
6424 for GDB's internal copy of the data. That's why the
6425 'to_fixed_xxx_type' routines take (target) addresses as parameters,
6426 rather than struct value*s.
6427
6428 However, GDB's internal history variables ($1, $2, etc.) are
6429 struct value*s containing internal copies of the data that are not, in
6430 general, the same as the data at their corresponding addresses in
6431 the target. Fortunately, the types we give to these values are all
6432 conventional, fixed-size types (as per the strategy described
6433 above), so that we don't usually have to perform the
6434 'to_fixed_xxx_type' conversions to look at their values.
6435 Unfortunately, there is one exception: if one of the internal
6436 history variables is an array whose elements are unconstrained
6437 records, then we will need to create distinct fixed types for each
6438 element selected. */
6439
6440 /* The upshot of all of this is that many routines take a (type, host
6441 address, target address) triple as arguments to represent a value.
6442 The host address, if non-null, is supposed to contain an internal
6443 copy of the relevant data; otherwise, the program is to consult the
6444 target at the target address. */
6445
6446 /* Assuming that VAL0 represents a pointer value, the result of
6447 dereferencing it. Differs from value_ind in its treatment of
6448 dynamic-sized types. */
6449
6450 struct value *
6451 ada_value_ind (struct value *val0)
6452 {
6453 struct value *val = unwrap_value (value_ind (val0));
6454 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
6455 }
6456
6457 /* The value resulting from dereferencing any "reference to"
6458 qualifiers on VAL0. */
6459
6460 static struct value *
6461 ada_coerce_ref (struct value *val0)
6462 {
6463 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (val0)) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6464 {
6465 struct value *val = val0;
6466 val = coerce_ref (val);
6467 val = unwrap_value (val);
6468 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
6469 }
6470 else
6471 return val0;
6472 }
6473
6474 /* Return OFF rounded upward if necessary to a multiple of
6475 ALIGNMENT (a power of 2). */
6476
6477 static unsigned int
6478 align_value (unsigned int off, unsigned int alignment)
6479 {
6480 return (off + alignment - 1) & ~(alignment - 1);
6481 }
6482
6483 /* Return the bit alignment required for field #F of template type TYPE. */
6484
6485 static unsigned int
6486 field_alignment (struct type *type, int f)
6487 {
6488 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
6489 int len;
6490 int align_offset;
6491
6492 /* The field name should never be null, unless the debugging information
6493 is somehow malformed. In this case, we assume the field does not
6494 require any alignment. */
6495 if (name == NULL)
6496 return 1;
6497
6498 len = strlen (name);
6499
6500 if (!isdigit (name[len - 1]))
6501 return 1;
6502
6503 if (isdigit (name[len - 2]))
6504 align_offset = len - 2;
6505 else
6506 align_offset = len - 1;
6507
6508 if (align_offset < 7 || strncmp ("___XV", name + align_offset - 6, 5) != 0)
6509 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6510
6511 return atoi (name + align_offset) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6512 }
6513
6514 /* Find a symbol named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. */
6515
6516 struct symbol *
6517 ada_find_any_symbol (const char *name)
6518 {
6519 struct symbol *sym;
6520
6521 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (NULL), VAR_DOMAIN);
6522 if (sym != NULL && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
6523 return sym;
6524
6525 sym = standard_lookup (name, NULL, STRUCT_DOMAIN);
6526 return sym;
6527 }
6528
6529 /* Find a type named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. This routine will look
6530 solely for types defined by debug info, it will not search the GDB
6531 primitive types. */
6532
6533 struct type *
6534 ada_find_any_type (const char *name)
6535 {
6536 struct symbol *sym = ada_find_any_symbol (name);
6537
6538 if (sym != NULL)
6539 return SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
6540
6541 return NULL;
6542 }
6543
6544 /* Given NAME and an associated BLOCK, search all symbols for
6545 NAME suffixed with "___XR", which is the ``renaming'' symbol
6546 associated to NAME. Return this symbol if found, return
6547 NULL otherwise. */
6548
6549 struct symbol *
6550 ada_find_renaming_symbol (const char *name, struct block *block)
6551 {
6552 struct symbol *sym;
6553
6554 sym = find_old_style_renaming_symbol (name, block);
6555
6556 if (sym != NULL)
6557 return sym;
6558
6559 /* Not right yet. FIXME pnh 7/20/2007. */
6560 sym = ada_find_any_symbol (name);
6561 if (sym != NULL && strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR") != NULL)
6562 return sym;
6563 else
6564 return NULL;
6565 }
6566
6567 static struct symbol *
6568 find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *name, struct block *block)
6569 {
6570 const struct symbol *function_sym = block_linkage_function (block);
6571 char *rename;
6572
6573 if (function_sym != NULL)
6574 {
6575 /* If the symbol is defined inside a function, NAME is not fully
6576 qualified. This means we need to prepend the function name
6577 as well as adding the ``___XR'' suffix to build the name of
6578 the associated renaming symbol. */
6579 char *function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (function_sym);
6580 /* Function names sometimes contain suffixes used
6581 for instance to qualify nested subprograms. When building
6582 the XR type name, we need to make sure that this suffix is
6583 not included. So do not include any suffix in the function
6584 name length below. */
6585 int function_name_len = ada_name_prefix_len (function_name);
6586 const int rename_len = function_name_len + 2 /* "__" */
6587 + strlen (name) + 6 /* "___XR\0" */ ;
6588
6589 /* Strip the suffix if necessary. */
6590 ada_remove_trailing_digits (function_name, &function_name_len);
6591 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (function_name, &function_name_len);
6592 ada_remove_Xbn_suffix (function_name, &function_name_len);
6593
6594 /* Library-level functions are a special case, as GNAT adds
6595 a ``_ada_'' prefix to the function name to avoid namespace
6596 pollution. However, the renaming symbols themselves do not
6597 have this prefix, so we need to skip this prefix if present. */
6598 if (function_name_len > 5 /* "_ada_" */
6599 && strstr (function_name, "_ada_") == function_name)
6600 {
6601 function_name += 5;
6602 function_name_len -= 5;
6603 }
6604
6605 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
6606 strncpy (rename, function_name, function_name_len);
6607 xsnprintf (rename + function_name_len, rename_len - function_name_len,
6608 "__%s___XR", name);
6609 }
6610 else
6611 {
6612 const int rename_len = strlen (name) + 6;
6613 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
6614 xsnprintf (rename, rename_len * sizeof (char), "%s___XR", name);
6615 }
6616
6617 return ada_find_any_symbol (rename);
6618 }
6619
6620 /* Because of GNAT encoding conventions, several GDB symbols may match a
6621 given type name. If the type denoted by TYPE0 is to be preferred to
6622 that of TYPE1 for purposes of type printing, return non-zero;
6623 otherwise return 0. */
6624
6625 int
6626 ada_prefer_type (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
6627 {
6628 if (type1 == NULL)
6629 return 1;
6630 else if (type0 == NULL)
6631 return 0;
6632 else if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
6633 return 1;
6634 else if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
6635 return 0;
6636 else if (TYPE_NAME (type1) == NULL && TYPE_NAME (type0) != NULL)
6637 return 1;
6638 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0))
6639 return 1;
6640 else if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type0)
6641 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type1))
6642 return 1;
6643 else
6644 {
6645 const char *type0_name = type_name_no_tag (type0);
6646 const char *type1_name = type_name_no_tag (type1);
6647
6648 if (type0_name != NULL && strstr (type0_name, "___XR") != NULL
6649 && (type1_name == NULL || strstr (type1_name, "___XR") == NULL))
6650 return 1;
6651 }
6652 return 0;
6653 }
6654
6655 /* The name of TYPE, which is either its TYPE_NAME, or, if that is
6656 null, its TYPE_TAG_NAME. Null if TYPE is null. */
6657
6658 char *
6659 ada_type_name (struct type *type)
6660 {
6661 if (type == NULL)
6662 return NULL;
6663 else if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL)
6664 return TYPE_NAME (type);
6665 else
6666 return TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
6667 }
6668
6669 /* Find a parallel type to TYPE whose name is formed by appending
6670 SUFFIX to the name of TYPE. */
6671
6672 struct type *
6673 ada_find_parallel_type (struct type *type, const char *suffix)
6674 {
6675 static char *name;
6676 static size_t name_len = 0;
6677 int len;
6678 char *typename = ada_type_name (type);
6679
6680 if (typename == NULL)
6681 return NULL;
6682
6683 len = strlen (typename);
6684
6685 GROW_VECT (name, name_len, len + strlen (suffix) + 1);
6686
6687 strcpy (name, typename);
6688 strcpy (name + len, suffix);
6689
6690 return ada_find_any_type (name);
6691 }
6692
6693
6694 /* If TYPE is a variable-size record type, return the corresponding template
6695 type describing its fields. Otherwise, return NULL. */
6696
6697 static struct type *
6698 dynamic_template_type (struct type *type)
6699 {
6700 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6701
6702 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
6703 || ada_type_name (type) == NULL)
6704 return NULL;
6705 else
6706 {
6707 int len = strlen (ada_type_name (type));
6708 if (len > 6 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type) + len - 6, "___XVE") == 0)
6709 return type;
6710 else
6711 return ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE");
6712 }
6713 }
6714
6715 /* Assuming that TEMPL_TYPE is a union or struct type, returns
6716 non-zero iff field FIELD_NUM of TEMPL_TYPE has dynamic size. */
6717
6718 static int
6719 is_dynamic_field (struct type *templ_type, int field_num)
6720 {
6721 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (templ_type, field_num);
6722 return name != NULL
6723 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (templ_type, field_num)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
6724 && strstr (name, "___XVL") != NULL;
6725 }
6726
6727 /* The index of the variant field of TYPE, or -1 if TYPE does not
6728 represent a variant record type. */
6729
6730 static int
6731 variant_field_index (struct type *type)
6732 {
6733 int f;
6734
6735 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
6736 return -1;
6737
6738 for (f = 0; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); f += 1)
6739 {
6740 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
6741 return f;
6742 }
6743 return -1;
6744 }
6745
6746 /* A record type with no fields. */
6747
6748 static struct type *
6749 empty_record (struct type *template)
6750 {
6751 struct type *type = alloc_type_copy (template);
6752 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
6753 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = 0;
6754 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = NULL;
6755 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type);
6756 TYPE_NAME (type) = "<empty>";
6757 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
6758 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
6759 return type;
6760 }
6761
6762 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
6763 the value of type TYPE at VALADDR or ADDRESS (see comments at
6764 the beginning of this section) VAL according to GNAT conventions.
6765 DVAL0 should describe the (portion of a) record that contains any
6766 necessary discriminants. It should be NULL if value_type (VAL) is
6767 an outer-level type (i.e., as opposed to a branch of a variant.) A
6768 variant field (unless unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch
6769 of the variant.
6770
6771 If not KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS, then all fields whose position or
6772 length are not statically known are discarded. As a consequence,
6773 VALADDR, ADDRESS and DVAL0 are ignored.
6774
6775 NOTE: Limitations: For now, we assume that dynamic fields and
6776 variants occupy whole numbers of bytes. However, they need not be
6777 byte-aligned. */
6778
6779 struct type *
6780 ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (struct type *type,
6781 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
6782 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0,
6783 int keep_dynamic_fields)
6784 {
6785 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
6786 struct value *dval;
6787 struct type *rtype;
6788 int nfields, bit_len;
6789 int variant_field;
6790 long off;
6791 int fld_bit_len, bit_incr;
6792 int f;
6793
6794 /* Compute the number of fields in this record type that are going
6795 to be processed: unless keep_dynamic_fields, this includes only
6796 fields whose position and length are static will be processed. */
6797 if (keep_dynamic_fields)
6798 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
6799 else
6800 {
6801 nfields = 0;
6802 while (nfields < TYPE_NFIELDS (type)
6803 && !ada_is_variant_part (type, nfields)
6804 && !is_dynamic_field (type, nfields))
6805 nfields++;
6806 }
6807
6808 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
6809 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
6810 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
6811 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
6812 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) = (struct field *)
6813 TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
6814 memset (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), 0, sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
6815 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
6816 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
6817 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
6818
6819 off = 0;
6820 bit_len = 0;
6821 variant_field = -1;
6822
6823 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
6824 {
6825 off = align_value (off, field_alignment (type, f))
6826 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, f);
6827 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, f) = off;
6828 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = 0;
6829
6830 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
6831 {
6832 variant_field = f;
6833 fld_bit_len = bit_incr = 0;
6834 }
6835 else if (is_dynamic_field (type, f))
6836 {
6837 const gdb_byte *field_valaddr = valaddr;
6838 CORE_ADDR field_address = address;
6839 struct type *field_type =
6840 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f));
6841
6842 if (dval0 == NULL)
6843 {
6844 /* rtype's length is computed based on the run-time
6845 value of discriminants. If the discriminants are not
6846 initialized, the type size may be completely bogus and
6847 GDB may fail to allocate a value for it. So check the
6848 size first before creating the value. */
6849 check_size (rtype);
6850 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (rtype, valaddr, address);
6851 }
6852 else
6853 dval = dval0;
6854
6855 /* If the type referenced by this field is an aligner type, we need
6856 to unwrap that aligner type, because its size might not be set.
6857 Keeping the aligner type would cause us to compute the wrong
6858 size for this field, impacting the offset of the all the fields
6859 that follow this one. */
6860 if (ada_is_aligner_type (field_type))
6861 {
6862 long field_offset = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, f);
6863
6864 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr, field_offset);
6865 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address, field_offset);
6866 field_type = ada_aligned_type (field_type);
6867 }
6868
6869 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr,
6870 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
6871 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address,
6872 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
6873
6874 /* Get the fixed type of the field. Note that, in this case,
6875 we do not want to get the real type out of the tag: if
6876 the current field is the parent part of a tagged record,
6877 we will get the tag of the object. Clearly wrong: the real
6878 type of the parent is not the real type of the child. We
6879 would end up in an infinite loop. */
6880 field_type = ada_get_base_type (field_type);
6881 field_type = ada_to_fixed_type (field_type, field_valaddr,
6882 field_address, dval, 0);
6883
6884 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = field_type;
6885 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
6886 bit_incr = fld_bit_len =
6887 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6888 }
6889 else
6890 {
6891 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
6892 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
6893 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f) > 0)
6894 bit_incr = fld_bit_len =
6895 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f);
6896 else
6897 bit_incr = fld_bit_len =
6898 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6899 }
6900 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
6901 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
6902 off += bit_incr;
6903 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
6904 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6905 }
6906
6907 /* We handle the variant part, if any, at the end because of certain
6908 odd cases in which it is re-ordered so as NOT to be the last field of
6909 the record. This can happen in the presence of representation
6910 clauses. */
6911 if (variant_field >= 0)
6912 {
6913 struct type *branch_type;
6914
6915 off = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, variant_field);
6916
6917 if (dval0 == NULL)
6918 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (rtype, valaddr, address);
6919 else
6920 dval = dval0;
6921
6922 branch_type =
6923 to_fixed_variant_branch_type
6924 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
6925 cond_offset_host (valaddr, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
6926 cond_offset_target (address, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
6927 if (branch_type == NULL)
6928 {
6929 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype); f += 1)
6930 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
6931 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
6932 }
6933 else
6934 {
6935 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
6936 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
6937 fld_bit_len =
6938 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field)) *
6939 TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6940 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
6941 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
6942 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
6943 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6944 }
6945 }
6946
6947 /* According to exp_dbug.ads, the size of TYPE for variable-size records
6948 should contain the alignment of that record, which should be a strictly
6949 positive value. If null or negative, then something is wrong, most
6950 probably in the debug info. In that case, we don't round up the size
6951 of the resulting type. If this record is not part of another structure,
6952 the current RTYPE length might be good enough for our purposes. */
6953 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) <= 0)
6954 {
6955 if (TYPE_NAME (rtype))
6956 warning (_("Invalid type size for `%s' detected: %d."),
6957 TYPE_NAME (rtype), TYPE_LENGTH (type));
6958 else
6959 warning (_("Invalid type size for <unnamed> detected: %d."),
6960 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
6961 }
6962 else
6963 {
6964 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = align_value (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype),
6965 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
6966 }
6967
6968 value_free_to_mark (mark);
6969 if (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) > varsize_limit)
6970 error (_("record type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
6971 return rtype;
6972 }
6973
6974 /* As for ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 with KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS
6975 of 1. */
6976
6977 static struct type *
6978 template_to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
6979 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
6980 {
6981 return ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (type, valaddr,
6982 address, dval0, 1);
6983 }
6984
6985 /* An ordinary record type in which ___XVL-convention fields and
6986 ___XVU- and ___XVN-convention field types in TYPE0 are replaced with
6987 static approximations, containing all possible fields. Uses
6988 no runtime values. Useless for use in values, but that's OK,
6989 since the results are used only for type determinations. Works on both
6990 structs and unions. Representation note: to save space, we memorize
6991 the result of this function in the TYPE_TARGET_TYPE of the
6992 template type. */
6993
6994 static struct type *
6995 template_to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
6996 {
6997 struct type *type;
6998 int nfields;
6999 int f;
7000
7001 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) != NULL)
7002 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
7003
7004 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type0);
7005 type = type0;
7006
7007 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
7008 {
7009 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type0, f));
7010 struct type *new_type;
7011
7012 if (is_dynamic_field (type0, f))
7013 new_type = to_static_fixed_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type));
7014 else
7015 new_type = static_unwrap_type (field_type);
7016 if (type == type0 && new_type != field_type)
7017 {
7018 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type = alloc_type_copy (type0);
7019 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE (type0);
7020 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type);
7021 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = nfields;
7022 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = (struct field *)
7023 TYPE_ALLOC (type, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7024 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (type), TYPE_FIELDS (type0),
7025 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7026 TYPE_NAME (type) = ada_type_name (type0);
7027 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
7028 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type) = 1;
7029 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
7030 }
7031 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f) = new_type;
7032 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type0, f);
7033 }
7034 return type;
7035 }
7036
7037 /* Given an object of type TYPE whose contents are at VALADDR and
7038 whose address in memory is ADDRESS, returns a revision of TYPE,
7039 which should be a non-dynamic-sized record, in which the variant
7040 part, if any, is replaced with the appropriate branch. Looks
7041 for discriminant values in DVAL0, which can be NULL if the record
7042 contains the necessary discriminant values. */
7043
7044 static struct type *
7045 to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7046 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
7047 {
7048 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
7049 struct value *dval;
7050 struct type *rtype;
7051 struct type *branch_type;
7052 int nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
7053 int variant_field = variant_field_index (type);
7054
7055 if (variant_field == -1)
7056 return type;
7057
7058 if (dval0 == NULL)
7059 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (type, valaddr, address);
7060 else
7061 dval = dval0;
7062
7063 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
7064 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
7065 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
7066 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
7067 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) =
7068 (struct field *) TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7069 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), TYPE_FIELDS (type),
7070 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7071 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
7072 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
7073 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
7074 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
7075
7076 branch_type = to_fixed_variant_branch_type
7077 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
7078 cond_offset_host (valaddr,
7079 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
7080 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
7081 cond_offset_target (address,
7082 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
7083 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
7084 if (branch_type == NULL)
7085 {
7086 int f;
7087 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < nfields; f += 1)
7088 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
7089 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
7090 }
7091 else
7092 {
7093 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
7094 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
7095 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, variant_field) = 0;
7096 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) += TYPE_LENGTH (branch_type);
7097 }
7098 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) -= TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field));
7099
7100 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7101 return rtype;
7102 }
7103
7104 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7105 the value at (TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS) [see explanation at
7106 beginning of this section]. Any necessary discriminants' values
7107 should be in DVAL, a record value; it may be NULL if the object
7108 at ADDR itself contains any necessary discriminant values.
7109 Additionally, VALADDR and ADDRESS may also be NULL if no discriminant
7110 values from the record are needed. Except in the case that DVAL,
7111 VALADDR, and ADDRESS are all 0 or NULL, a variant field (unless
7112 unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch of the variant.
7113
7114 NOTE: the case in which DVAL and VALADDR are NULL and ADDRESS is 0
7115 is questionable and may be removed. It can arise during the
7116 processing of an unconstrained-array-of-record type where all the
7117 variant branches have exactly the same size. This is because in
7118 such cases, the compiler does not bother to use the XVS convention
7119 when encoding the record. I am currently dubious of this
7120 shortcut and suspect the compiler should be altered. FIXME. */
7121
7122 static struct type *
7123 to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7124 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
7125 {
7126 struct type *templ_type;
7127
7128 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
7129 return type0;
7130
7131 templ_type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
7132
7133 if (templ_type != NULL)
7134 return template_to_fixed_record_type (templ_type, valaddr, address, dval);
7135 else if (variant_field_index (type0) >= 0)
7136 {
7137 if (dval == NULL && valaddr == NULL && address == 0)
7138 return type0;
7139 return to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (type0, valaddr, address,
7140 dval);
7141 }
7142 else
7143 {
7144 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0) = 1;
7145 return type0;
7146 }
7147
7148 }
7149
7150 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7151 the value at (VAR_TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS), where VAR_TYPE0 is a
7152 union type. Any necessary discriminants' values should be in DVAL,
7153 a record value. That is, this routine selects the appropriate
7154 branch of the union at ADDR according to the discriminant value
7155 indicated in the union's type name. Returns VAR_TYPE0 itself if
7156 it represents a variant subject to a pragma Unchecked_Union. */
7157
7158 static struct type *
7159 to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *var_type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7160 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
7161 {
7162 int which;
7163 struct type *templ_type;
7164 struct type *var_type;
7165
7166 if (TYPE_CODE (var_type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
7167 var_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (var_type0);
7168 else
7169 var_type = var_type0;
7170
7171 templ_type = ada_find_parallel_type (var_type, "___XVU");
7172
7173 if (templ_type != NULL)
7174 var_type = templ_type;
7175
7176 if (is_unchecked_variant (var_type, value_type (dval)))
7177 return var_type0;
7178 which =
7179 ada_which_variant_applies (var_type,
7180 value_type (dval), value_contents (dval));
7181
7182 if (which < 0)
7183 return empty_record (var_type);
7184 else if (is_dynamic_field (var_type, which))
7185 return to_fixed_record_type
7186 (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)),
7187 valaddr, address, dval);
7188 else if (variant_field_index (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)) >= 0)
7189 return
7190 to_fixed_record_type
7191 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which), valaddr, address, dval);
7192 else
7193 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which);
7194 }
7195
7196 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is an array type describing the type of a value
7197 at ADDR, and that DVAL describes a record containing any
7198 discriminants used in TYPE0, returns a type for the value that
7199 contains no dynamic components (that is, no components whose sizes
7200 are determined by run-time quantities). Unless IGNORE_TOO_BIG is
7201 true, gives an error message if the resulting type's size is over
7202 varsize_limit. */
7203
7204 static struct type *
7205 to_fixed_array_type (struct type *type0, struct value *dval,
7206 int ignore_too_big)
7207 {
7208 struct type *index_type_desc;
7209 struct type *result;
7210 int constrained_packed_array_p;
7211
7212 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
7213 return type0;
7214
7215 constrained_packed_array_p = ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
7216 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
7217 type0 = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
7218
7219 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XA");
7220 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
7221 {
7222 struct type *elt_type0 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0));
7223 /* NOTE: elt_type---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
7224 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
7225 debugging data. */
7226 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
7227 We're not providing the address of an element here,
7228 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
7229 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
7230 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
7231 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
7232 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
7233 consult the object tag. */
7234 struct type *elt_type = ada_to_fixed_type (elt_type0, 0, 0, dval, 1);
7235
7236 /* Make sure we always create a new array type when dealing with
7237 packed array types, since we're going to fix-up the array
7238 type length and element bitsize a little further down. */
7239 if (elt_type0 == elt_type && !constrained_packed_array_p)
7240 result = type0;
7241 else
7242 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (type0),
7243 elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
7244 }
7245 else
7246 {
7247 int i;
7248 struct type *elt_type0;
7249
7250 elt_type0 = type0;
7251 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc); i > 0; i -= 1)
7252 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
7253
7254 /* NOTE: result---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
7255 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
7256 debugging data. */
7257 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
7258 We're not providing the address of an element here,
7259 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
7260 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
7261 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
7262 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
7263 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
7264 consult the object tag. */
7265 result =
7266 ada_to_fixed_type (ada_check_typedef (elt_type0), 0, 0, dval, 1);
7267
7268 elt_type0 = type0;
7269 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
7270 {
7271 struct type *range_type =
7272 to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_type_desc, i),
7273 dval, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type0));
7274 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (elt_type0),
7275 result, range_type);
7276 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
7277 }
7278 if (!ignore_too_big && TYPE_LENGTH (result) > varsize_limit)
7279 error (_("array type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
7280 }
7281
7282 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
7283 {
7284 /* So far, the resulting type has been created as if the original
7285 type was a regular (non-packed) array type. As a result, the
7286 bitsize of the array elements needs to be set again, and the array
7287 length needs to be recomputed based on that bitsize. */
7288 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (result) / TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (result));
7289 int elt_bitsize = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
7290
7291 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (result, 0) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
7292 TYPE_LENGTH (result) = len * elt_bitsize / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
7293 if (TYPE_LENGTH (result) * HOST_CHAR_BIT < len * elt_bitsize)
7294 TYPE_LENGTH (result)++;
7295 }
7296
7297 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (result) = 1;
7298 return result;
7299 }
7300
7301
7302 /* A standard type (containing no dynamically sized components)
7303 corresponding to TYPE for the value (TYPE, VALADDR, ADDRESS)
7304 DVAL describes a record containing any discriminants used in TYPE0,
7305 and may be NULL if there are none, or if the object of type TYPE at
7306 ADDRESS or in VALADDR contains these discriminants.
7307
7308 If CHECK_TAG is not null, in the case of tagged types, this function
7309 attempts to locate the object's tag and use it to compute the actual
7310 type. However, when ADDRESS is null, we cannot use it to determine the
7311 location of the tag, and therefore compute the tagged type's actual type.
7312 So we return the tagged type without consulting the tag. */
7313
7314 static struct type *
7315 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7316 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
7317 {
7318 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7319 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
7320 {
7321 default:
7322 return type;
7323 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
7324 {
7325 struct type *static_type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
7326 struct type *fixed_record_type =
7327 to_fixed_record_type (type, valaddr, address, NULL);
7328 /* If STATIC_TYPE is a tagged type and we know the object's address,
7329 then we can determine its tag, and compute the object's actual
7330 type from there. Note that we have to use the fixed record
7331 type (the parent part of the record may have dynamic fields
7332 and the way the location of _tag is expressed may depend on
7333 them). */
7334
7335 if (check_tag && address != 0 && ada_is_tagged_type (static_type, 0))
7336 {
7337 struct type *real_type =
7338 type_from_tag (value_tag_from_contents_and_address
7339 (fixed_record_type,
7340 valaddr,
7341 address));
7342 if (real_type != NULL)
7343 return to_fixed_record_type (real_type, valaddr, address, NULL);
7344 }
7345
7346 /* Check to see if there is a parallel ___XVZ variable.
7347 If there is, then it provides the actual size of our type. */
7348 else if (ada_type_name (fixed_record_type) != NULL)
7349 {
7350 char *name = ada_type_name (fixed_record_type);
7351 char *xvz_name = alloca (strlen (name) + 7 /* "___XVZ\0" */);
7352 int xvz_found = 0;
7353 LONGEST size;
7354
7355 xsnprintf (xvz_name, strlen (name) + 7, "%s___XVZ", name);
7356 size = get_int_var_value (xvz_name, &xvz_found);
7357 if (xvz_found && TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) != size)
7358 {
7359 fixed_record_type = copy_type (fixed_record_type);
7360 TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) = size;
7361
7362 /* The FIXED_RECORD_TYPE may have be a stub. We have
7363 observed this when the debugging info is STABS, and
7364 apparently it is something that is hard to fix.
7365
7366 In practice, we don't need the actual type definition
7367 at all, because the presence of the XVZ variable allows us
7368 to assume that there must be a XVS type as well, which we
7369 should be able to use later, when we need the actual type
7370 definition.
7371
7372 In the meantime, pretend that the "fixed" type we are
7373 returning is NOT a stub, because this can cause trouble
7374 when using this type to create new types targeting it.
7375 Indeed, the associated creation routines often check
7376 whether the target type is a stub and will try to replace
7377 it, thus using a type with the wrong size. This, in turn,
7378 might cause the new type to have the wrong size too.
7379 Consider the case of an array, for instance, where the size
7380 of the array is computed from the number of elements in
7381 our array multiplied by the size of its element. */
7382 TYPE_STUB (fixed_record_type) = 0;
7383 }
7384 }
7385 return fixed_record_type;
7386 }
7387 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
7388 return to_fixed_array_type (type, dval, 1);
7389 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
7390 if (dval == NULL)
7391 return type;
7392 else
7393 return to_fixed_variant_branch_type (type, valaddr, address, dval);
7394 }
7395 }
7396
7397 /* The same as ada_to_fixed_type_1, except that it preserves the type
7398 if it is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF of a type that is already fixed.
7399 ada_to_fixed_type_1 would return the type referenced by TYPE. */
7400
7401 struct type *
7402 ada_to_fixed_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7403 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
7404
7405 {
7406 struct type *fixed_type =
7407 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (type, valaddr, address, dval, check_tag);
7408
7409 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
7410 && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == fixed_type)
7411 return type;
7412
7413 return fixed_type;
7414 }
7415
7416 /* A standard (static-sized) type corresponding as well as possible to
7417 TYPE0, but based on no runtime data. */
7418
7419 static struct type *
7420 to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
7421 {
7422 struct type *type;
7423
7424 if (type0 == NULL)
7425 return NULL;
7426
7427 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
7428 return type0;
7429
7430 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
7431
7432 switch (TYPE_CODE (type0))
7433 {
7434 default:
7435 return type0;
7436 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
7437 type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
7438 if (type != NULL)
7439 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
7440 else
7441 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
7442 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
7443 type = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XVU");
7444 if (type != NULL)
7445 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
7446 else
7447 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
7448 }
7449 }
7450
7451 /* A static approximation of TYPE with all type wrappers removed. */
7452
7453 static struct type *
7454 static_unwrap_type (struct type *type)
7455 {
7456 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7457 {
7458 struct type *type1 = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (type), 0);
7459 if (ada_type_name (type1) == NULL)
7460 TYPE_NAME (type1) = ada_type_name (type);
7461
7462 return static_unwrap_type (type1);
7463 }
7464 else
7465 {
7466 struct type *raw_real_type = ada_get_base_type (type);
7467 if (raw_real_type == type)
7468 return type;
7469 else
7470 return to_static_fixed_type (raw_real_type);
7471 }
7472 }
7473
7474 /* In some cases, incomplete and private types require
7475 cross-references that are not resolved as records (for example,
7476 type Foo;
7477 type FooP is access Foo;
7478 V: FooP;
7479 type Foo is array ...;
7480 ). In these cases, since there is no mechanism for producing
7481 cross-references to such types, we instead substitute for FooP a
7482 stub enumeration type that is nowhere resolved, and whose tag is
7483 the name of the actual type. Call these types "non-record stubs". */
7484
7485 /* A type equivalent to TYPE that is not a non-record stub, if one
7486 exists, otherwise TYPE. */
7487
7488 struct type *
7489 ada_check_typedef (struct type *type)
7490 {
7491 if (type == NULL)
7492 return NULL;
7493
7494 CHECK_TYPEDEF (type);
7495 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
7496 || !TYPE_STUB (type)
7497 || TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) == NULL)
7498 return type;
7499 else
7500 {
7501 char *name = TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
7502 struct type *type1 = ada_find_any_type (name);
7503 return (type1 == NULL) ? type : type1;
7504 }
7505 }
7506
7507 /* A value representing the data at VALADDR/ADDRESS as described by
7508 type TYPE0, but with a standard (static-sized) type that correctly
7509 describes it. If VAL0 is not NULL and TYPE0 already is a standard
7510 type, then return VAL0 [this feature is simply to avoid redundant
7511 creation of struct values]. */
7512
7513 static struct value *
7514 ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *type0, CORE_ADDR address,
7515 struct value *val0)
7516 {
7517 struct type *type = ada_to_fixed_type (type0, 0, address, NULL, 1);
7518 if (type == type0 && val0 != NULL)
7519 return val0;
7520 else
7521 return value_from_contents_and_address (type, 0, address);
7522 }
7523
7524 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type
7525 that correctly describes it. Does not necessarily create a new
7526 value. */
7527
7528 static struct value *
7529 ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *val)
7530 {
7531 return ada_to_fixed_value_create (value_type (val),
7532 value_address (val),
7533 val);
7534 }
7535
7536 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type
7537 chosen to approximate the real type of VAL as well as possible, but
7538 without consulting any runtime values. For Ada dynamic-sized
7539 types, therefore, the type of the result is likely to be inaccurate. */
7540
7541 static struct value *
7542 ada_to_static_fixed_value (struct value *val)
7543 {
7544 struct type *type =
7545 to_static_fixed_type (static_unwrap_type (value_type (val)));
7546 if (type == value_type (val))
7547 return val;
7548 else
7549 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (val, type);
7550 }
7551 \f
7552
7553 /* Attributes */
7554
7555 /* Table mapping attribute numbers to names.
7556 NOTE: Keep up to date with enum ada_attribute definition in ada-lang.h. */
7557
7558 static const char *attribute_names[] = {
7559 "<?>",
7560
7561 "first",
7562 "last",
7563 "length",
7564 "image",
7565 "max",
7566 "min",
7567 "modulus",
7568 "pos",
7569 "size",
7570 "tag",
7571 "val",
7572 0
7573 };
7574
7575 const char *
7576 ada_attribute_name (enum exp_opcode n)
7577 {
7578 if (n >= OP_ATR_FIRST && n <= (int) OP_ATR_VAL)
7579 return attribute_names[n - OP_ATR_FIRST + 1];
7580 else
7581 return attribute_names[0];
7582 }
7583
7584 /* Evaluate the 'POS attribute applied to ARG. */
7585
7586 static LONGEST
7587 pos_atr (struct value *arg)
7588 {
7589 struct value *val = coerce_ref (arg);
7590 struct type *type = value_type (val);
7591
7592 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
7593 error (_("'POS only defined on discrete types"));
7594
7595 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
7596 {
7597 int i;
7598 LONGEST v = value_as_long (val);
7599
7600 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7601 {
7602 if (v == TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i))
7603 return i;
7604 }
7605 error (_("enumeration value is invalid: can't find 'POS"));
7606 }
7607 else
7608 return value_as_long (val);
7609 }
7610
7611 static struct value *
7612 value_pos_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
7613 {
7614 return value_from_longest (type, pos_atr (arg));
7615 }
7616
7617 /* Evaluate the TYPE'VAL attribute applied to ARG. */
7618
7619 static struct value *
7620 value_val_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
7621 {
7622 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
7623 error (_("'VAL only defined on discrete types"));
7624 if (!integer_type_p (value_type (arg)))
7625 error (_("'VAL requires integral argument"));
7626
7627 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
7628 {
7629 long pos = value_as_long (arg);
7630 if (pos < 0 || pos >= TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
7631 error (_("argument to 'VAL out of range"));
7632 return value_from_longest (type, TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, pos));
7633 }
7634 else
7635 return value_from_longest (type, value_as_long (arg));
7636 }
7637 \f
7638
7639 /* Evaluation */
7640
7641 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada character type.
7642 [At the moment, this is true only for Character and Wide_Character;
7643 It is a heuristic test that could stand improvement]. */
7644
7645 int
7646 ada_is_character_type (struct type *type)
7647 {
7648 const char *name;
7649
7650 /* If the type code says it's a character, then assume it really is,
7651 and don't check any further. */
7652 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_CHAR)
7653 return 1;
7654
7655 /* Otherwise, assume it's a character type iff it is a discrete type
7656 with a known character type name. */
7657 name = ada_type_name (type);
7658 return (name != NULL
7659 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
7660 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
7661 && (strcmp (name, "character") == 0
7662 || strcmp (name, "wide_character") == 0
7663 || strcmp (name, "wide_wide_character") == 0
7664 || strcmp (name, "unsigned char") == 0));
7665 }
7666
7667 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada string type. */
7668
7669 int
7670 ada_is_string_type (struct type *type)
7671 {
7672 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7673 if (type != NULL
7674 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
7675 && (ada_is_simple_array_type (type)
7676 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
7677 && ada_array_arity (type) == 1)
7678 {
7679 struct type *elttype = ada_array_element_type (type, 1);
7680
7681 return ada_is_character_type (elttype);
7682 }
7683 else
7684 return 0;
7685 }
7686
7687
7688 /* True if TYPE is a struct type introduced by the compiler to force the
7689 alignment of a value. Such types have a single field with a
7690 distinctive name. */
7691
7692 int
7693 ada_is_aligner_type (struct type *type)
7694 {
7695 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7696
7697 /* If we can find a parallel XVS type, then the XVS type should
7698 be used instead of this type. And hence, this is not an aligner
7699 type. */
7700 if (ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVS") != NULL)
7701 return 0;
7702
7703 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7704 && TYPE_NFIELDS (type) == 1
7705 && strcmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0), "F") == 0);
7706 }
7707
7708 /* If there is an ___XVS-convention type parallel to SUBTYPE, return
7709 the parallel type. */
7710
7711 struct type *
7712 ada_get_base_type (struct type *raw_type)
7713 {
7714 struct type *real_type_namer;
7715 struct type *raw_real_type;
7716
7717 if (raw_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (raw_type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
7718 return raw_type;
7719
7720 if (ada_is_aligner_type (raw_type))
7721 /* The encoding specifies that we should always use the aligner type.
7722 So, even if this aligner type has an associated XVS type, we should
7723 simply ignore it.
7724
7725 According to the compiler gurus, an XVS type parallel to an aligner
7726 type may exist because of a stabs limitation. In stabs, aligner
7727 types are empty because the field has a variable-sized type, and
7728 thus cannot actually be used as an aligner type. As a result,
7729 we need the associated parallel XVS type to decode the type.
7730 Since the policy in the compiler is to not change the internal
7731 representation based on the debugging info format, we sometimes
7732 end up having a redundant XVS type parallel to the aligner type. */
7733 return raw_type;
7734
7735 real_type_namer = ada_find_parallel_type (raw_type, "___XVS");
7736 if (real_type_namer == NULL
7737 || TYPE_CODE (real_type_namer) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7738 || TYPE_NFIELDS (real_type_namer) != 1)
7739 return raw_type;
7740
7741 raw_real_type = ada_find_any_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (real_type_namer, 0));
7742 if (raw_real_type == NULL)
7743 return raw_type;
7744 else
7745 return raw_real_type;
7746 }
7747
7748 /* The type of value designated by TYPE, with all aligners removed. */
7749
7750 struct type *
7751 ada_aligned_type (struct type *type)
7752 {
7753 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7754 return ada_aligned_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
7755 else
7756 return ada_get_base_type (type);
7757 }
7758
7759
7760 /* The address of the aligned value in an object at address VALADDR
7761 having type TYPE. Assumes ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE). */
7762
7763 const gdb_byte *
7764 ada_aligned_value_addr (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr)
7765 {
7766 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7767 return ada_aligned_value_addr (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0),
7768 valaddr +
7769 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type,
7770 0) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
7771 else
7772 return valaddr;
7773 }
7774
7775
7776
7777 /* The printed representation of an enumeration literal with encoded
7778 name NAME. The value is good to the next call of ada_enum_name. */
7779 const char *
7780 ada_enum_name (const char *name)
7781 {
7782 static char *result;
7783 static size_t result_len = 0;
7784 char *tmp;
7785
7786 /* First, unqualify the enumeration name:
7787 1. Search for the last '.' character. If we find one, then skip
7788 all the preceeding characters, the unqualified name starts
7789 right after that dot.
7790 2. Otherwise, we may be debugging on a target where the compiler
7791 translates dots into "__". Search forward for double underscores,
7792 but stop searching when we hit an overloading suffix, which is
7793 of the form "__" followed by digits. */
7794
7795 tmp = strrchr (name, '.');
7796 if (tmp != NULL)
7797 name = tmp + 1;
7798 else
7799 {
7800 while ((tmp = strstr (name, "__")) != NULL)
7801 {
7802 if (isdigit (tmp[2]))
7803 break;
7804 else
7805 name = tmp + 2;
7806 }
7807 }
7808
7809 if (name[0] == 'Q')
7810 {
7811 int v;
7812 if (name[1] == 'U' || name[1] == 'W')
7813 {
7814 if (sscanf (name + 2, "%x", &v) != 1)
7815 return name;
7816 }
7817 else
7818 return name;
7819
7820 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, 16);
7821 if (isascii (v) && isprint (v))
7822 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "'%c'", v);
7823 else if (name[1] == 'U')
7824 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%02x\"]", v);
7825 else
7826 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%04x\"]", v);
7827
7828 return result;
7829 }
7830 else
7831 {
7832 tmp = strstr (name, "__");
7833 if (tmp == NULL)
7834 tmp = strstr (name, "$");
7835 if (tmp != NULL)
7836 {
7837 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, tmp - name + 1);
7838 strncpy (result, name, tmp - name);
7839 result[tmp - name] = '\0';
7840 return result;
7841 }
7842
7843 return name;
7844 }
7845 }
7846
7847 /* Evaluate the subexpression of EXP starting at *POS as for
7848 evaluate_type, updating *POS to point just past the evaluated
7849 expression. */
7850
7851 static struct value *
7852 evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *exp, int *pos)
7853 {
7854 return evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
7855 }
7856
7857 /* If VAL is wrapped in an aligner or subtype wrapper, return the
7858 value it wraps. */
7859
7860 static struct value *
7861 unwrap_value (struct value *val)
7862 {
7863 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
7864 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7865 {
7866 struct value *v = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "F", 0);
7867 struct type *val_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (v));
7868 if (ada_type_name (val_type) == NULL)
7869 TYPE_NAME (val_type) = ada_type_name (type);
7870
7871 return unwrap_value (v);
7872 }
7873 else
7874 {
7875 struct type *raw_real_type =
7876 ada_check_typedef (ada_get_base_type (type));
7877
7878 if (type == raw_real_type)
7879 return val;
7880
7881 return
7882 coerce_unspec_val_to_type
7883 (val, ada_to_fixed_type (raw_real_type, 0,
7884 value_address (val),
7885 NULL, 1));
7886 }
7887 }
7888
7889 static struct value *
7890 cast_to_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
7891 {
7892 LONGEST val;
7893
7894 if (type == value_type (arg))
7895 return arg;
7896 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg)))
7897 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type,
7898 ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
7899 value_as_long (arg)));
7900 else
7901 {
7902 DOUBLEST argd = value_as_double (arg);
7903 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type, argd);
7904 }
7905
7906 return value_from_longest (type, val);
7907 }
7908
7909 static struct value *
7910 cast_from_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
7911 {
7912 DOUBLEST val = ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
7913 value_as_long (arg));
7914 return value_from_double (type, val);
7915 }
7916
7917 /* Coerce VAL as necessary for assignment to an lval of type TYPE, and
7918 return the converted value. */
7919
7920 static struct value *
7921 coerce_for_assign (struct type *type, struct value *val)
7922 {
7923 struct type *type2 = value_type (val);
7924 if (type == type2)
7925 return val;
7926
7927 type2 = ada_check_typedef (type2);
7928 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7929
7930 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
7931 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
7932 {
7933 val = ada_value_ind (val);
7934 type2 = value_type (val);
7935 }
7936
7937 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
7938 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
7939 {
7940 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type2) != TYPE_LENGTH (type)
7941 || TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
7942 != TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2)))
7943 error (_("Incompatible types in assignment"));
7944 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
7945 }
7946 return val;
7947 }
7948
7949 static struct value *
7950 ada_value_binop (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2, enum exp_opcode op)
7951 {
7952 struct value *val;
7953 struct type *type1, *type2;
7954 LONGEST v, v1, v2;
7955
7956 arg1 = coerce_ref (arg1);
7957 arg2 = coerce_ref (arg2);
7958 type1 = base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1)));
7959 type2 = base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)));
7960
7961 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) != TYPE_CODE_INT
7962 || TYPE_CODE (type2) != TYPE_CODE_INT)
7963 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
7964
7965 switch (op)
7966 {
7967 case BINOP_MOD:
7968 case BINOP_DIV:
7969 case BINOP_REM:
7970 break;
7971 default:
7972 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
7973 }
7974
7975 v2 = value_as_long (arg2);
7976 if (v2 == 0)
7977 error (_("second operand of %s must not be zero."), op_string (op));
7978
7979 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type1) || op == BINOP_MOD)
7980 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
7981
7982 v1 = value_as_long (arg1);
7983 switch (op)
7984 {
7985 case BINOP_DIV:
7986 v = v1 / v2;
7987 if (!TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO && v1 * (v1 % v2) < 0)
7988 v += v > 0 ? -1 : 1;
7989 break;
7990 case BINOP_REM:
7991 v = v1 % v2;
7992 if (v * v1 < 0)
7993 v -= v2;
7994 break;
7995 default:
7996 /* Should not reach this point. */
7997 v = 0;
7998 }
7999
8000 val = allocate_value (type1);
8001 store_unsigned_integer (value_contents_raw (val),
8002 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)),
8003 gdbarch_byte_order (get_type_arch (type1)), v);
8004 return val;
8005 }
8006
8007 static int
8008 ada_value_equal (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2)
8009 {
8010 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg1))
8011 || ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg2)))
8012 {
8013 /* Automatically dereference any array reference before
8014 we attempt to perform the comparison. */
8015 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
8016 arg2 = ada_coerce_ref (arg2);
8017
8018 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
8019 arg2 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg2);
8020 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8021 || TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg2)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8022 error (_("Attempt to compare array with non-array"));
8023 /* FIXME: The following works only for types whose
8024 representations use all bits (no padding or undefined bits)
8025 and do not have user-defined equality. */
8026 return
8027 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg2))
8028 && memcmp (value_contents (arg1), value_contents (arg2),
8029 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1))) == 0;
8030 }
8031 return value_equal (arg1, arg2);
8032 }
8033
8034 /* Total number of component associations in the aggregate starting at
8035 index PC in EXP. Assumes that index PC is the start of an
8036 OP_AGGREGATE. */
8037
8038 static int
8039 num_component_specs (struct expression *exp, int pc)
8040 {
8041 int n, m, i;
8042 m = exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
8043 pc += 3;
8044 n = 0;
8045 for (i = 0; i < m; i += 1)
8046 {
8047 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
8048 {
8049 default:
8050 n += 1;
8051 break;
8052 case OP_CHOICES:
8053 n += exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
8054 break;
8055 }
8056 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &pc, EVAL_SKIP);
8057 }
8058 return n;
8059 }
8060
8061 /* Assign the result of evaluating EXP starting at *POS to the INDEXth
8062 component of LHS (a simple array or a record), updating *POS past
8063 the expression, assuming that LHS is contained in CONTAINER. Does
8064 not modify the inferior's memory, nor does it modify LHS (unless
8065 LHS == CONTAINER). */
8066
8067 static void
8068 assign_component (struct value *container, struct value *lhs, LONGEST index,
8069 struct expression *exp, int *pos)
8070 {
8071 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8072 struct value *elt;
8073 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (lhs)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8074 {
8075 struct type *index_type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
8076 struct value *index_val = value_from_longest (index_type, index);
8077 elt = unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript (lhs, 1, &index_val));
8078 }
8079 else
8080 {
8081 elt = ada_index_struct_field (index, lhs, 0, value_type (lhs));
8082 elt = ada_to_fixed_value (unwrap_value (elt));
8083 }
8084
8085 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
8086 assign_aggregate (container, elt, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
8087 else
8088 value_assign_to_component (container, elt,
8089 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8090 EVAL_NORMAL));
8091
8092 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8093 }
8094
8095 /* Assuming that LHS represents an lvalue having a record or array
8096 type, and EXP->ELTS[*POS] is an OP_AGGREGATE, evaluate an assignment
8097 of that aggregate's value to LHS, advancing *POS past the
8098 aggregate. NOSIDE is as for evaluate_subexp. CONTAINER is an
8099 lvalue containing LHS (possibly LHS itself). Does not modify
8100 the inferior's memory, nor does it modify the contents of
8101 LHS (unless == CONTAINER). Returns the modified CONTAINER. */
8102
8103 static struct value *
8104 assign_aggregate (struct value *container,
8105 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8106 int *pos, enum noside noside)
8107 {
8108 struct type *lhs_type;
8109 int n = exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst;
8110 LONGEST low_index, high_index;
8111 int num_specs;
8112 LONGEST *indices;
8113 int max_indices, num_indices;
8114 int is_array_aggregate;
8115 int i;
8116 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8117
8118 *pos += 3;
8119 if (noside != EVAL_NORMAL)
8120 {
8121 int i;
8122 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
8123 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
8124 return container;
8125 }
8126
8127 container = ada_coerce_ref (container);
8128 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (container)))
8129 container = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (container);
8130 lhs = ada_coerce_ref (lhs);
8131 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (lhs))
8132 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
8133
8134 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
8135 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (lhs_type))
8136 {
8137 lhs = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (lhs);
8138 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
8139 low_index = TYPE_ARRAY_LOWER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
8140 high_index = TYPE_ARRAY_UPPER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
8141 is_array_aggregate = 1;
8142 }
8143 else if (TYPE_CODE (lhs_type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
8144 {
8145 low_index = 0;
8146 high_index = num_visible_fields (lhs_type) - 1;
8147 is_array_aggregate = 0;
8148 }
8149 else
8150 error (_("Left-hand side must be array or record."));
8151
8152 num_specs = num_component_specs (exp, *pos - 3);
8153 max_indices = 4 * num_specs + 4;
8154 indices = alloca (max_indices * sizeof (indices[0]));
8155 indices[0] = indices[1] = low_index - 1;
8156 indices[2] = indices[3] = high_index + 1;
8157 num_indices = 4;
8158
8159 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
8160 {
8161 switch (exp->elts[*pos].opcode)
8162 {
8163 case OP_CHOICES:
8164 aggregate_assign_from_choices (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8165 &num_indices, max_indices,
8166 low_index, high_index);
8167 break;
8168 case OP_POSITIONAL:
8169 aggregate_assign_positional (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8170 &num_indices, max_indices,
8171 low_index, high_index);
8172 break;
8173 case OP_OTHERS:
8174 if (i != n-1)
8175 error (_("Misplaced 'others' clause"));
8176 aggregate_assign_others (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8177 num_indices, low_index, high_index);
8178 break;
8179 default:
8180 error (_("Internal error: bad aggregate clause"));
8181 }
8182 }
8183
8184 return container;
8185 }
8186
8187 /* Assign into the component of LHS indexed by the OP_POSITIONAL
8188 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
8189 the positions are relative to lower bound LOW, where HIGH is the
8190 upper bound. Record the position in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1]
8191 updating *NUM_INDICES as needed. CONTAINER is as for
8192 assign_aggregate. */
8193 static void
8194 aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *container,
8195 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8196 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
8197 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8198 {
8199 LONGEST ind = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 1].longconst) + low;
8200
8201 if (ind - 1 == high)
8202 warning (_("Extra components in aggregate ignored."));
8203 if (ind <= high)
8204 {
8205 add_component_interval (ind, ind, indices, num_indices, max_indices);
8206 *pos += 3;
8207 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, pos);
8208 }
8209 else
8210 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8211 }
8212
8213 /* Assign into the components of LHS indexed by the OP_CHOICES
8214 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
8215 the allowable indices are LOW..HIGH. Record the indices assigned
8216 to in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1], updating *NUM_INDICES as
8217 needed. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
8218 static void
8219 aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *container,
8220 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8221 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
8222 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8223 {
8224 int j;
8225 int n_choices = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst);
8226 int choice_pos, expr_pc;
8227 int is_array = ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (lhs));
8228
8229 choice_pos = *pos += 3;
8230
8231 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
8232 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8233 expr_pc = *pos;
8234 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8235
8236 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
8237 {
8238 LONGEST lower, upper;
8239 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[choice_pos].opcode;
8240 if (op == OP_DISCRETE_RANGE)
8241 {
8242 choice_pos += 1;
8243 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8244 EVAL_NORMAL));
8245 upper = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8246 EVAL_NORMAL));
8247 }
8248 else if (is_array)
8249 {
8250 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos,
8251 EVAL_NORMAL));
8252 upper = lower;
8253 }
8254 else
8255 {
8256 int ind;
8257 char *name;
8258 switch (op)
8259 {
8260 case OP_NAME:
8261 name = &exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].string;
8262 break;
8263 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
8264 name = SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].symbol);
8265 break;
8266 default:
8267 error (_("Invalid record component association."));
8268 }
8269 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8270 ind = 0;
8271 if (! find_struct_field (name, value_type (lhs), 0,
8272 NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &ind))
8273 error (_("Unknown component name: %s."), name);
8274 lower = upper = ind;
8275 }
8276
8277 if (lower <= upper && (lower < low || upper > high))
8278 error (_("Index in component association out of bounds."));
8279
8280 add_component_interval (lower, upper, indices, num_indices,
8281 max_indices);
8282 while (lower <= upper)
8283 {
8284 int pos1;
8285 pos1 = expr_pc;
8286 assign_component (container, lhs, lower, exp, &pos1);
8287 lower += 1;
8288 }
8289 }
8290 }
8291
8292 /* Assign the value of the expression in the OP_OTHERS construct in
8293 EXP at *POS into the components of LHS indexed from LOW .. HIGH that
8294 have not been previously assigned. The index intervals already assigned
8295 are in INDICES[0 .. NUM_INDICES-1]. Updates *POS to after the
8296 OP_OTHERS clause. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate*/
8297 static void
8298 aggregate_assign_others (struct value *container,
8299 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8300 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int num_indices,
8301 LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8302 {
8303 int i;
8304 int expr_pc = *pos+1;
8305
8306 for (i = 0; i < num_indices - 2; i += 2)
8307 {
8308 LONGEST ind;
8309 for (ind = indices[i + 1] + 1; ind < indices[i + 2]; ind += 1)
8310 {
8311 int pos;
8312 pos = expr_pc;
8313 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, &pos);
8314 }
8315 }
8316 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8317 }
8318
8319 /* Add the interval [LOW .. HIGH] to the sorted set of intervals
8320 [ INDICES[0] .. INDICES[1] ],..., [ INDICES[*SIZE-2] .. INDICES[*SIZE-1] ],
8321 modifying *SIZE as needed. It is an error if *SIZE exceeds
8322 MAX_SIZE. The resulting intervals do not overlap. */
8323 static void
8324 add_component_interval (LONGEST low, LONGEST high,
8325 LONGEST* indices, int *size, int max_size)
8326 {
8327 int i, j;
8328 for (i = 0; i < *size; i += 2) {
8329 if (high >= indices[i] && low <= indices[i + 1])
8330 {
8331 int kh;
8332 for (kh = i + 2; kh < *size; kh += 2)
8333 if (high < indices[kh])
8334 break;
8335 if (low < indices[i])
8336 indices[i] = low;
8337 indices[i + 1] = indices[kh - 1];
8338 if (high > indices[i + 1])
8339 indices[i + 1] = high;
8340 memcpy (indices + i + 2, indices + kh, *size - kh);
8341 *size -= kh - i - 2;
8342 return;
8343 }
8344 else if (high < indices[i])
8345 break;
8346 }
8347
8348 if (*size == max_size)
8349 error (_("Internal error: miscounted aggregate components."));
8350 *size += 2;
8351 for (j = *size-1; j >= i+2; j -= 1)
8352 indices[j] = indices[j - 2];
8353 indices[i] = low;
8354 indices[i + 1] = high;
8355 }
8356
8357 /* Perform and Ada cast of ARG2 to type TYPE if the type of ARG2
8358 is different. */
8359
8360 static struct value *
8361 ada_value_cast (struct type *type, struct value *arg2, enum noside noside)
8362 {
8363 if (type == ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)))
8364 return arg2;
8365
8366 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (type))
8367 return (cast_to_fixed (type, arg2));
8368
8369 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8370 return cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
8371
8372 return value_cast (type, arg2);
8373 }
8374
8375 /* Evaluating Ada expressions, and printing their result.
8376 ------------------------------------------------------
8377
8378 1. Introduction:
8379 ----------------
8380
8381 We usually evaluate an Ada expression in order to print its value.
8382 We also evaluate an expression in order to print its type, which
8383 happens during the EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase of the evaluation,
8384 but we'll focus mostly on the EVAL_NORMAL phase. In practice, the
8385 EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase allows us to simplify certain aspects of
8386 the evaluation compared to the EVAL_NORMAL, but is otherwise very
8387 similar.
8388
8389 Evaluating expressions is a little more complicated for Ada entities
8390 than it is for entities in languages such as C. The main reason for
8391 this is that Ada provides types whose definition might be dynamic.
8392 One example of such types is variant records. Or another example
8393 would be an array whose bounds can only be known at run time.
8394
8395 The following description is a general guide as to what should be
8396 done (and what should NOT be done) in order to evaluate an expression
8397 involving such types, and when. This does not cover how the semantic
8398 information is encoded by GNAT as this is covered separatly. For the
8399 document used as the reference for the GNAT encoding, see exp_dbug.ads
8400 in the GNAT sources.
8401
8402 Ideally, we should embed each part of this description next to its
8403 associated code. Unfortunately, the amount of code is so vast right
8404 now that it's hard to see whether the code handling a particular
8405 situation might be duplicated or not. One day, when the code is
8406 cleaned up, this guide might become redundant with the comments
8407 inserted in the code, and we might want to remove it.
8408
8409 2. ``Fixing'' an Entity, the Simple Case:
8410 -----------------------------------------
8411
8412 When evaluating Ada expressions, the tricky issue is that they may
8413 reference entities whose type contents and size are not statically
8414 known. Consider for instance a variant record:
8415
8416 type Rec (Empty : Boolean := True) is record
8417 case Empty is
8418 when True => null;
8419 when False => Value : Integer;
8420 end case;
8421 end record;
8422 Yes : Rec := (Empty => False, Value => 1);
8423 No : Rec := (empty => True);
8424
8425 The size and contents of that record depends on the value of the
8426 descriminant (Rec.Empty). At this point, neither the debugging
8427 information nor the associated type structure in GDB are able to
8428 express such dynamic types. So what the debugger does is to create
8429 "fixed" versions of the type that applies to the specific object.
8430 We also informally refer to this opperation as "fixing" an object,
8431 which means creating its associated fixed type.
8432
8433 Example: when printing the value of variable "Yes" above, its fixed
8434 type would look like this:
8435
8436 type Rec is record
8437 Empty : Boolean;
8438 Value : Integer;
8439 end record;
8440
8441 On the other hand, if we printed the value of "No", its fixed type
8442 would become:
8443
8444 type Rec is record
8445 Empty : Boolean;
8446 end record;
8447
8448 Things become a little more complicated when trying to fix an entity
8449 with a dynamic type that directly contains another dynamic type,
8450 such as an array of variant records, for instance. There are
8451 two possible cases: Arrays, and records.
8452
8453 3. ``Fixing'' Arrays:
8454 ---------------------
8455
8456 The type structure in GDB describes an array in terms of its bounds,
8457 and the type of its elements. By design, all elements in the array
8458 have the same type and we cannot represent an array of variant elements
8459 using the current type structure in GDB. When fixing an array,
8460 we cannot fix the array element, as we would potentially need one
8461 fixed type per element of the array. As a result, the best we can do
8462 when fixing an array is to produce an array whose bounds and size
8463 are correct (allowing us to read it from memory), but without having
8464 touched its element type. Fixing each element will be done later,
8465 when (if) necessary.
8466
8467 Arrays are a little simpler to handle than records, because the same
8468 amount of memory is allocated for each element of the array, even if
8469 the amount of space actually used by each element differs from element
8470 to element. Consider for instance the following array of type Rec:
8471
8472 type Rec_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Rec;
8473
8474 The actual amount of memory occupied by each element might be different
8475 from element to element, depending on the value of their discriminant.
8476 But the amount of space reserved for each element in the array remains
8477 fixed regardless. So we simply need to compute that size using
8478 the debugging information available, from which we can then determine
8479 the array size (we multiply the number of elements of the array by
8480 the size of each element).
8481
8482 The simplest case is when we have an array of a constrained element
8483 type. For instance, consider the following type declarations:
8484
8485 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Integer) is
8486 Length : Integer;
8487 Buffer : String (1 .. Max_Size);
8488 end record;
8489 type Bounded_String_Array is array (1 ..2) of Bounded_String (80);
8490
8491 In this case, the compiler describes the array as an array of
8492 variable-size elements (identified by its XVS suffix) for which
8493 the size can be read in the parallel XVZ variable.
8494
8495 In the case of an array of an unconstrained element type, the compiler
8496 wraps the array element inside a private PAD type. This type should not
8497 be shown to the user, and must be "unwrap"'ed before printing. Note
8498 that we also use the adjective "aligner" in our code to designate
8499 these wrapper types.
8500
8501 In some cases, the size allocated for each element is statically
8502 known. In that case, the PAD type already has the correct size,
8503 and the array element should remain unfixed.
8504
8505 But there are cases when this size is not statically known.
8506 For instance, assuming that "Five" is an integer variable:
8507
8508 type Dynamic is array (1 .. Five) of Integer;
8509 type Wrapper (Has_Length : Boolean := False) is record
8510 Data : Dynamic;
8511 case Has_Length is
8512 when True => Length : Integer;
8513 when False => null;
8514 end case;
8515 end record;
8516 type Wrapper_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Wrapper;
8517
8518 Hello : Wrapper_Array := (others => (Has_Length => True,
8519 Data => (others => 17),
8520 Length => 1));
8521
8522
8523 The debugging info would describe variable Hello as being an
8524 array of a PAD type. The size of that PAD type is not statically
8525 known, but can be determined using a parallel XVZ variable.
8526 In that case, a copy of the PAD type with the correct size should
8527 be used for the fixed array.
8528
8529 3. ``Fixing'' record type objects:
8530 ----------------------------------
8531
8532 Things are slightly different from arrays in the case of dynamic
8533 record types. In this case, in order to compute the associated
8534 fixed type, we need to determine the size and offset of each of
8535 its components. This, in turn, requires us to compute the fixed
8536 type of each of these components.
8537
8538 Consider for instance the example:
8539
8540 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Natural) is record
8541 Str : String (1 .. Max_Size);
8542 Length : Natural;
8543 end record;
8544 My_String : Bounded_String (Max_Size => 10);
8545
8546 In that case, the position of field "Length" depends on the size
8547 of field Str, which itself depends on the value of the Max_Size
8548 discriminant. In order to fix the type of variable My_String,
8549 we need to fix the type of field Str. Therefore, fixing a variant
8550 record requires us to fix each of its components.
8551
8552 However, if a component does not have a dynamic size, the component
8553 should not be fixed. In particular, fields that use a PAD type
8554 should not fixed. Here is an example where this might happen
8555 (assuming type Rec above):
8556
8557 type Container (Big : Boolean) is record
8558 First : Rec;
8559 After : Integer;
8560 case Big is
8561 when True => Another : Integer;
8562 when False => null;
8563 end case;
8564 end record;
8565 My_Container : Container := (Big => False,
8566 First => (Empty => True),
8567 After => 42);
8568
8569 In that example, the compiler creates a PAD type for component First,
8570 whose size is constant, and then positions the component After just
8571 right after it. The offset of component After is therefore constant
8572 in this case.
8573
8574 The debugger computes the position of each field based on an algorithm
8575 that uses, among other things, the actual position and size of the field
8576 preceding it. Let's now imagine that the user is trying to print
8577 the value of My_Container. If the type fixing was recursive, we would
8578 end up computing the offset of field After based on the size of the
8579 fixed version of field First. And since in our example First has
8580 only one actual field, the size of the fixed type is actually smaller
8581 than the amount of space allocated to that field, and thus we would
8582 compute the wrong offset of field After.
8583
8584 To make things more complicated, we need to watch out for dynamic
8585 components of variant records (identified by the ___XVL suffix in
8586 the component name). Even if the target type is a PAD type, the size
8587 of that type might not be statically known. So the PAD type needs
8588 to be unwrapped and the resulting type needs to be fixed. Otherwise,
8589 we might end up with the wrong size for our component. This can be
8590 observed with the following type declarations:
8591
8592 type Octal is new Integer range 0 .. 7;
8593 type Octal_Array is array (Positive range <>) of Octal;
8594 pragma Pack (Octal_Array);
8595
8596 type Octal_Buffer (Size : Positive) is record
8597 Buffer : Octal_Array (1 .. Size);
8598 Length : Integer;
8599 end record;
8600
8601 In that case, Buffer is a PAD type whose size is unset and needs
8602 to be computed by fixing the unwrapped type.
8603
8604 4. When to ``Fix'' un-``Fixed'' sub-elements of an entity:
8605 ----------------------------------------------------------
8606
8607 Lastly, when should the sub-elements of an entity that remained unfixed
8608 thus far, be actually fixed?
8609
8610 The answer is: Only when referencing that element. For instance
8611 when selecting one component of a record, this specific component
8612 should be fixed at that point in time. Or when printing the value
8613 of a record, each component should be fixed before its value gets
8614 printed. Similarly for arrays, the element of the array should be
8615 fixed when printing each element of the array, or when extracting
8616 one element out of that array. On the other hand, fixing should
8617 not be performed on the elements when taking a slice of an array!
8618
8619 Note that one of the side-effects of miscomputing the offset and
8620 size of each field is that we end up also miscomputing the size
8621 of the containing type. This can have adverse results when computing
8622 the value of an entity. GDB fetches the value of an entity based
8623 on the size of its type, and thus a wrong size causes GDB to fetch
8624 the wrong amount of memory. In the case where the computed size is
8625 too small, GDB fetches too little data to print the value of our
8626 entiry. Results in this case as unpredicatble, as we usually read
8627 past the buffer containing the data =:-o. */
8628
8629 /* Implement the evaluate_exp routine in the exp_descriptor structure
8630 for the Ada language. */
8631
8632 static struct value *
8633 ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *expect_type, struct expression *exp,
8634 int *pos, enum noside noside)
8635 {
8636 enum exp_opcode op;
8637 int tem, tem2, tem3;
8638 int pc;
8639 struct value *arg1 = NULL, *arg2 = NULL, *arg3;
8640 struct type *type;
8641 int nargs, oplen;
8642 struct value **argvec;
8643
8644 pc = *pos;
8645 *pos += 1;
8646 op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
8647
8648 switch (op)
8649 {
8650 default:
8651 *pos -= 1;
8652 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8653 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
8654
8655 /* If evaluating an OP_DOUBLE and an EXPECT_TYPE was provided,
8656 then we need to perform the conversion manually, because
8657 evaluate_subexp_standard doesn't do it. This conversion is
8658 necessary in Ada because the different kinds of float/fixed
8659 types in Ada have different representations.
8660
8661 Similarly, we need to perform the conversion from OP_LONG
8662 ourselves. */
8663 if ((op == OP_DOUBLE || op == OP_LONG) && expect_type != NULL)
8664 arg1 = ada_value_cast (expect_type, arg1, noside);
8665
8666 return arg1;
8667
8668 case OP_STRING:
8669 {
8670 struct value *result;
8671 *pos -= 1;
8672 result = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8673 /* The result type will have code OP_STRING, bashed there from
8674 OP_ARRAY. Bash it back. */
8675 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) == TYPE_CODE_STRING)
8676 TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) = TYPE_CODE_ARRAY;
8677 return result;
8678 }
8679
8680 case UNOP_CAST:
8681 (*pos) += 2;
8682 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
8683 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
8684 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8685 goto nosideret;
8686 arg1 = ada_value_cast (type, arg1, noside);
8687 return arg1;
8688
8689 case UNOP_QUAL:
8690 (*pos) += 2;
8691 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
8692 return ada_evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
8693
8694 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
8695 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8696 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
8697 {
8698 arg1 = assign_aggregate (arg1, arg1, exp, pos, noside);
8699 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8700 return arg1;
8701 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg1);
8702 }
8703 /* Force the evaluation of the rhs ARG2 to the type of the lhs ARG1,
8704 except if the lhs of our assignment is a convenience variable.
8705 In the case of assigning to a convenience variable, the lhs
8706 should be exactly the result of the evaluation of the rhs. */
8707 type = value_type (arg1);
8708 if (VALUE_LVAL (arg1) == lval_internalvar)
8709 type = NULL;
8710 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
8711 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8712 return arg1;
8713 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
8714 arg2 = cast_to_fixed (value_type (arg1), arg2);
8715 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8716 error
8717 (_("Fixed-point values must be assigned to fixed-point variables"));
8718 else
8719 arg2 = coerce_for_assign (value_type (arg1), arg2);
8720 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg2);
8721
8722 case BINOP_ADD:
8723 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8724 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8725 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8726 goto nosideret;
8727 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8728 return (value_from_longest
8729 (value_type (arg1),
8730 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2)));
8731 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
8732 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8733 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
8734 error (_("Operands of fixed-point addition must have the same type"));
8735 /* Do the addition, and cast the result to the type of the first
8736 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
8737 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
8738 type = value_type (arg1);
8739 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
8740 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
8741 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8742 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_ADD));
8743
8744 case BINOP_SUB:
8745 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8746 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8747 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8748 goto nosideret;
8749 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8750 return (value_from_longest
8751 (value_type (arg1),
8752 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2)));
8753 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
8754 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8755 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
8756 error (_("Operands of fixed-point subtraction must have the same type"));
8757 /* Do the substraction, and cast the result to the type of the first
8758 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
8759 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
8760 type = value_type (arg1);
8761 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
8762 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
8763 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8764 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_SUB));
8765
8766 case BINOP_MUL:
8767 case BINOP_DIV:
8768 case BINOP_REM:
8769 case BINOP_MOD:
8770 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8771 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8772 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8773 goto nosideret;
8774 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8775 {
8776 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8777 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
8778 }
8779 else
8780 {
8781 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_double;
8782 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
8783 arg1 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg1);
8784 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8785 arg2 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
8786 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8787 return ada_value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
8788 }
8789
8790 case BINOP_EQUAL:
8791 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
8792 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8793 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (value_type (arg1), exp, pos, noside);
8794 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8795 goto nosideret;
8796 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8797 tem = 0;
8798 else
8799 {
8800 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8801 tem = ada_value_equal (arg1, arg2);
8802 }
8803 if (op == BINOP_NOTEQUAL)
8804 tem = !tem;
8805 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
8806 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) tem);
8807
8808 case UNOP_NEG:
8809 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8810 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8811 goto nosideret;
8812 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
8813 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), value_neg (arg1));
8814 else
8815 {
8816 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
8817 return value_neg (arg1);
8818 }
8819
8820 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
8821 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
8822 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
8823 {
8824 struct value *val;
8825
8826 *pos -= 1;
8827 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8828 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
8829 return value_cast (type, val);
8830 }
8831
8832 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
8833 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
8834 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
8835 {
8836 struct value *val;
8837
8838 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
8839 *pos = pc;
8840 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8841
8842 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), val);
8843 }
8844
8845 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
8846 *pos -= 1;
8847
8848 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8849 {
8850 *pos += 4;
8851 goto nosideret;
8852 }
8853 else if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
8854 /* Only encountered when an unresolved symbol occurs in a
8855 context other than a function call, in which case, it is
8856 invalid. */
8857 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
8858 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
8859 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8860 {
8861 type = static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
8862 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 0))
8863 {
8864 /* Tagged types are a little special in the fact that the real
8865 type is dynamic and can only be determined by inspecting the
8866 object's tag. This means that we need to get the object's
8867 value first (EVAL_NORMAL) and then extract the actual object
8868 type from its tag.
8869
8870 Note that we cannot skip the final step where we extract
8871 the object type from its tag, because the EVAL_NORMAL phase
8872 results in dynamic components being resolved into fixed ones.
8873 This can cause problems when trying to print the type
8874 description of tagged types whose parent has a dynamic size:
8875 We use the type name of the "_parent" component in order
8876 to print the name of the ancestor type in the type description.
8877 If that component had a dynamic size, the resolution into
8878 a fixed type would result in the loss of that type name,
8879 thus preventing us from printing the name of the ancestor
8880 type in the type description. */
8881 struct type *actual_type;
8882
8883 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
8884 actual_type = type_from_tag (ada_value_tag (arg1));
8885 if (actual_type == NULL)
8886 /* If, for some reason, we were unable to determine
8887 the actual type from the tag, then use the static
8888 approximation that we just computed as a fallback.
8889 This can happen if the debugging information is
8890 incomplete, for instance. */
8891 actual_type = type;
8892
8893 return value_zero (actual_type, not_lval);
8894 }
8895
8896 *pos += 4;
8897 return value_zero
8898 (to_static_fixed_type
8899 (static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))),
8900 not_lval);
8901 }
8902 else
8903 {
8904 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8905 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
8906 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
8907 }
8908
8909 case OP_FUNCALL:
8910 (*pos) += 2;
8911
8912 /* Allocate arg vector, including space for the function to be
8913 called in argvec[0] and a terminating NULL. */
8914 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
8915 argvec =
8916 (struct value **) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 2));
8917
8918 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
8919 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
8920 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
8921 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
8922 else
8923 {
8924 for (tem = 0; tem <= nargs; tem += 1)
8925 argvec[tem] = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8926 argvec[tem] = 0;
8927
8928 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8929 goto nosideret;
8930 }
8931
8932 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type
8933 (desc_base_type (value_type (argvec[0]))))
8934 argvec[0] = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]);
8935 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8936 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (value_type (argvec[0]), 0) != 0)
8937 /* This is a packed array that has already been fixed, and
8938 therefore already coerced to a simple array. Nothing further
8939 to do. */
8940 ;
8941 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_REF
8942 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8943 && VALUE_LVAL (argvec[0]) == lval_memory))
8944 argvec[0] = value_addr (argvec[0]);
8945
8946 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (argvec[0]));
8947 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8948 {
8949 switch (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))))
8950 {
8951 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
8952 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
8953 break;
8954 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
8955 break;
8956 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8957 if (noside != EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8958 argvec[0] = ada_value_ind (argvec[0]);
8959 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
8960 break;
8961 default:
8962 error (_("cannot subscript or call something of type `%s'"),
8963 ada_type_name (value_type (argvec[0])));
8964 break;
8965 }
8966 }
8967
8968 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
8969 {
8970 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
8971 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8972 return allocate_value (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
8973 return call_function_by_hand (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1);
8974 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8975 {
8976 int arity;
8977
8978 arity = ada_array_arity (type);
8979 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
8980 if (type == NULL)
8981 error (_("cannot subscript or call a record"));
8982 if (arity != nargs)
8983 error (_("wrong number of subscripts; expecting %d"), arity);
8984 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8985 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
8986 return
8987 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
8988 (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1));
8989 }
8990 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
8991 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8992 {
8993 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
8994 if (type == NULL)
8995 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
8996 else
8997 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
8998 }
8999 return
9000 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
9001 (ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]),
9002 nargs, argvec + 1));
9003 case TYPE_CODE_PTR: /* Pointer to array */
9004 type = to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, 1);
9005 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9006 {
9007 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
9008 if (type == NULL)
9009 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
9010 else
9011 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
9012 }
9013 return
9014 unwrap_value (ada_value_ptr_subscript (argvec[0], type,
9015 nargs, argvec + 1));
9016
9017 default:
9018 error (_("Attempt to index or call something other than an "
9019 "array or function"));
9020 }
9021
9022 case TERNOP_SLICE:
9023 {
9024 struct value *array = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9025 struct value *low_bound_val =
9026 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9027 struct value *high_bound_val =
9028 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9029 LONGEST low_bound;
9030 LONGEST high_bound;
9031 low_bound_val = coerce_ref (low_bound_val);
9032 high_bound_val = coerce_ref (high_bound_val);
9033 low_bound = pos_atr (low_bound_val);
9034 high_bound = pos_atr (high_bound_val);
9035
9036 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9037 goto nosideret;
9038
9039 /* If this is a reference to an aligner type, then remove all
9040 the aligners. */
9041 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9042 && ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array))))
9043 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)) =
9044 ada_aligned_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)));
9045
9046 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (array)))
9047 error (_("cannot slice a packed array"));
9048
9049 /* If this is a reference to an array or an array lvalue,
9050 convert to a pointer. */
9051 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9052 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9053 && VALUE_LVAL (array) == lval_memory))
9054 array = value_addr (array);
9055
9056 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS
9057 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ada_check_typedef
9058 (value_type (array))))
9059 return empty_array (ada_type_of_array (array, 0), low_bound);
9060
9061 array = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (array);
9062
9063 /* If we have more than one level of pointer indirection,
9064 dereference the value until we get only one level. */
9065 while (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
9066 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)))
9067 == TYPE_CODE_PTR))
9068 array = value_ind (array);
9069
9070 /* Make sure we really do have an array type before going further,
9071 to avoid a SEGV when trying to get the index type or the target
9072 type later down the road if the debug info generated by
9073 the compiler is incorrect or incomplete. */
9074 if (!ada_is_simple_array_type (value_type (array)))
9075 error (_("cannot take slice of non-array"));
9076
9077 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
9078 {
9079 if (high_bound < low_bound || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9080 return empty_array (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)),
9081 low_bound);
9082 else
9083 {
9084 struct type *arr_type0 =
9085 to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)),
9086 NULL, 1);
9087 return ada_value_slice_from_ptr (array, arr_type0,
9088 longest_to_int (low_bound),
9089 longest_to_int (high_bound));
9090 }
9091 }
9092 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9093 return array;
9094 else if (high_bound < low_bound)
9095 return empty_array (value_type (array), low_bound);
9096 else
9097 return ada_value_slice (array, longest_to_int (low_bound),
9098 longest_to_int (high_bound));
9099 }
9100
9101 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
9102 (*pos) += 2;
9103 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9104 type = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
9105
9106 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9107 goto nosideret;
9108
9109 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
9110 {
9111 default:
9112 lim_warning (_("Membership test incompletely implemented; "
9113 "always returns true"));
9114 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9115 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) 1);
9116
9117 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
9118 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type));
9119 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type));
9120 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9121 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
9122 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9123 return
9124 value_from_longest (type,
9125 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
9126 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
9127 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
9128 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
9129 }
9130
9131 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
9132 (*pos) += 2;
9133 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9134 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9135
9136 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9137 goto nosideret;
9138
9139 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9140 {
9141 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9142 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
9143 }
9144
9145 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
9146
9147 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg2), tem, "range");
9148 if (!type)
9149 type = value_type (arg1);
9150
9151 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 1));
9152 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 0));
9153
9154 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9155 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
9156 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9157 return
9158 value_from_longest (type,
9159 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
9160 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
9161 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
9162 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
9163
9164 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
9165 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9166 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9167 arg3 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9168
9169 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9170 goto nosideret;
9171
9172 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9173 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
9174 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9175 return
9176 value_from_longest (type,
9177 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
9178 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
9179 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
9180 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
9181
9182 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
9183 case OP_ATR_LAST:
9184 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
9185 {
9186 struct type *type_arg;
9187 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
9188 {
9189 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9190 arg1 = NULL;
9191 type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
9192 }
9193 else
9194 {
9195 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9196 type_arg = NULL;
9197 }
9198
9199 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode != OP_LONG)
9200 error (_("Invalid operand to '%s"), ada_attribute_name (op));
9201 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 2].longconst);
9202 *pos += 4;
9203
9204 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9205 goto nosideret;
9206
9207 if (type_arg == NULL)
9208 {
9209 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
9210
9211 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arg1)))
9212 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
9213
9214 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg1), tem,
9215 ada_attribute_name (op));
9216 if (type == NULL)
9217 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9218
9219 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9220 return allocate_value (type);
9221
9222 switch (op)
9223 {
9224 default: /* Should never happen. */
9225 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
9226 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
9227 return value_from_longest
9228 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 0));
9229 case OP_ATR_LAST:
9230 return value_from_longest
9231 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 1));
9232 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
9233 return value_from_longest
9234 (type, ada_array_length (arg1, tem));
9235 }
9236 }
9237 else if (discrete_type_p (type_arg))
9238 {
9239 struct type *range_type;
9240 char *name = ada_type_name (type_arg);
9241 range_type = NULL;
9242 if (name != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type_arg) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
9243 range_type = to_fixed_range_type (name, NULL, type_arg);
9244 if (range_type == NULL)
9245 range_type = type_arg;
9246 switch (op)
9247 {
9248 default:
9249 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
9250 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
9251 return value_from_longest
9252 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_low_bound (range_type));
9253 case OP_ATR_LAST:
9254 return value_from_longest
9255 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_high_bound (range_type));
9256 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
9257 error (_("the 'length attribute applies only to array types"));
9258 }
9259 }
9260 else if (TYPE_CODE (type_arg) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
9261 error (_("unimplemented type attribute"));
9262 else
9263 {
9264 LONGEST low, high;
9265
9266 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg))
9267 type_arg = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg);
9268
9269 type = ada_index_type (type_arg, tem, ada_attribute_name (op));
9270 if (type == NULL)
9271 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9272
9273 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9274 return allocate_value (type);
9275
9276 switch (op)
9277 {
9278 default:
9279 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
9280 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
9281 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
9282 return value_from_longest (type, low);
9283 case OP_ATR_LAST:
9284 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
9285 return value_from_longest (type, high);
9286 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
9287 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
9288 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
9289 return value_from_longest (type, high - low + 1);
9290 }
9291 }
9292 }
9293
9294 case OP_ATR_TAG:
9295 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9296 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9297 goto nosideret;
9298
9299 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9300 return value_zero (ada_tag_type (arg1), not_lval);
9301
9302 return ada_value_tag (arg1);
9303
9304 case OP_ATR_MIN:
9305 case OP_ATR_MAX:
9306 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9307 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9308 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9309 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9310 goto nosideret;
9311 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9312 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
9313 else
9314 {
9315 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9316 return value_binop (arg1, arg2,
9317 op == OP_ATR_MIN ? BINOP_MIN : BINOP_MAX);
9318 }
9319
9320 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
9321 {
9322 struct type *type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
9323 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9324
9325 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9326 goto nosideret;
9327
9328 if (!ada_is_modular_type (type_arg))
9329 error (_("'modulus must be applied to modular type"));
9330
9331 return value_from_longest (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type_arg),
9332 ada_modulus (type_arg));
9333 }
9334
9335
9336 case OP_ATR_POS:
9337 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9338 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9339 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9340 goto nosideret;
9341 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9342 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9343 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
9344 else
9345 return value_pos_atr (type, arg1);
9346
9347 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
9348 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9349 type = value_type (arg1);
9350
9351 /* If the argument is a reference, then dereference its type, since
9352 the user is really asking for the size of the actual object,
9353 not the size of the pointer. */
9354 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
9355 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9356
9357 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9358 goto nosideret;
9359 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9360 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, not_lval);
9361 else
9362 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
9363 TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (type));
9364
9365 case OP_ATR_VAL:
9366 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9367 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9368 type = exp->elts[pc + 2].type;
9369 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9370 goto nosideret;
9371 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9372 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
9373 else
9374 return value_val_atr (type, arg1);
9375
9376 case BINOP_EXP:
9377 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9378 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9379 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9380 goto nosideret;
9381 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9382 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
9383 else
9384 {
9385 /* For integer exponentiation operations,
9386 only promote the first argument. */
9387 if (is_integral_type (value_type (arg2)))
9388 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
9389 else
9390 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9391
9392 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9393 }
9394
9395 case UNOP_PLUS:
9396 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9397 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9398 goto nosideret;
9399 else
9400 return arg1;
9401
9402 case UNOP_ABS:
9403 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9404 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9405 goto nosideret;
9406 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
9407 if (value_less (arg1, value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval)))
9408 return value_neg (arg1);
9409 else
9410 return arg1;
9411
9412 case UNOP_IND:
9413 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9414 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9415 goto nosideret;
9416 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
9417 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9418 {
9419 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
9420 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
9421 {
9422 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arg1, 0);
9423 if (arrType == NULL)
9424 error (_("Attempt to dereference null array pointer."));
9425 return value_at_lazy (arrType, 0);
9426 }
9427 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
9428 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9429 /* In C you can dereference an array to get the 1st elt. */
9430 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9431 {
9432 type = to_static_fixed_type
9433 (ada_aligned_type
9434 (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))));
9435 check_size (type);
9436 return value_zero (type, lval_memory);
9437 }
9438 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
9439 {
9440 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. */
9441 if (expect_type == NULL)
9442 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
9443 lval_memory);
9444 else
9445 {
9446 expect_type =
9447 to_static_fixed_type (ada_aligned_type (expect_type));
9448 return value_zero (expect_type, lval_memory);
9449 }
9450 }
9451 else
9452 error (_("Attempt to take contents of a non-pointer value."));
9453 }
9454 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1); /* FIXME: What is this for?? */
9455 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
9456
9457 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
9458 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. If we were given
9459 the expect_type, then use that as the target type.
9460 Otherwise, assume that the target type is an int. */
9461 {
9462 if (expect_type != NULL)
9463 return ada_value_ind (value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (expect_type),
9464 arg1));
9465 else
9466 return value_at_lazy (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
9467 (CORE_ADDR) value_as_address (arg1));
9468 }
9469
9470 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
9471 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
9472 return ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
9473 else
9474 return ada_value_ind (arg1);
9475
9476 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
9477 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
9478 (*pos) += 3 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (tem + 1);
9479 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9480 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9481 goto nosideret;
9482 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9483 {
9484 struct type *type1 = value_type (arg1);
9485 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type1, 1))
9486 {
9487 type = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1,
9488 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string,
9489 1, 1, NULL);
9490 if (type == NULL)
9491 /* In this case, we assume that the field COULD exist
9492 in some extension of the type. Return an object of
9493 "type" void, which will match any formal
9494 (see ada_type_match). */
9495 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_void,
9496 lval_memory);
9497 }
9498 else
9499 type =
9500 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 1,
9501 0, NULL);
9502
9503 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
9504 }
9505 else
9506 arg1 = ada_value_struct_elt (arg1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 0);
9507 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
9508 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
9509
9510 case OP_TYPE:
9511 /* The value is not supposed to be used. This is here to make it
9512 easier to accommodate expressions that contain types. */
9513 (*pos) += 2;
9514 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9515 goto nosideret;
9516 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9517 return allocate_value (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
9518 else
9519 error (_("Attempt to use a type name as an expression"));
9520
9521 case OP_AGGREGATE:
9522 case OP_CHOICES:
9523 case OP_OTHERS:
9524 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
9525 case OP_POSITIONAL:
9526 case OP_NAME:
9527 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
9528 switch (op)
9529 {
9530 case OP_NAME:
9531 error (_("Undefined name, ambiguous name, or renaming used in "
9532 "component association: %s."), &exp->elts[pc+2].string);
9533 case OP_AGGREGATE:
9534 error (_("Aggregates only allowed on the right of an assignment"));
9535 default:
9536 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("aggregate apparently mangled"));
9537 }
9538
9539 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
9540 *pos += oplen - 1;
9541 for (tem = 0; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
9542 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
9543 goto nosideret;
9544 }
9545
9546 nosideret:
9547 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, 1);
9548 }
9549 \f
9550
9551 /* Fixed point */
9552
9553 /* If TYPE encodes an Ada fixed-point type, return the suffix of the
9554 type name that encodes the 'small and 'delta information.
9555 Otherwise, return NULL. */
9556
9557 static const char *
9558 fixed_type_info (struct type *type)
9559 {
9560 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
9561 enum type_code code = (type == NULL) ? TYPE_CODE_UNDEF : TYPE_CODE (type);
9562
9563 if ((code == TYPE_CODE_INT || code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) && name != NULL)
9564 {
9565 const char *tail = strstr (name, "___XF_");
9566 if (tail == NULL)
9567 return NULL;
9568 else
9569 return tail + 5;
9570 }
9571 else if (code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != type)
9572 return fixed_type_info (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
9573 else
9574 return NULL;
9575 }
9576
9577 /* Returns non-zero iff TYPE represents an Ada fixed-point type. */
9578
9579 int
9580 ada_is_fixed_point_type (struct type *type)
9581 {
9582 return fixed_type_info (type) != NULL;
9583 }
9584
9585 /* Return non-zero iff TYPE represents a System.Address type. */
9586
9587 int
9588 ada_is_system_address_type (struct type *type)
9589 {
9590 return (TYPE_NAME (type)
9591 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (type), "system__address") == 0);
9592 }
9593
9594 /* Assuming that TYPE is the representation of an Ada fixed-point
9595 type, return its delta, or -1 if the type is malformed and the
9596 delta cannot be determined. */
9597
9598 DOUBLEST
9599 ada_delta (struct type *type)
9600 {
9601 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
9602 DOUBLEST num, den;
9603
9604 /* Strictly speaking, num and den are encoded as integer. However,
9605 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted
9606 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */
9607 if (sscanf (encoding, "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT,
9608 &num, &den) < 2)
9609 return -1.0;
9610 else
9611 return num / den;
9612 }
9613
9614 /* Assuming that ada_is_fixed_point_type (TYPE), return the scaling
9615 factor ('SMALL value) associated with the type. */
9616
9617 static DOUBLEST
9618 scaling_factor (struct type *type)
9619 {
9620 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
9621 DOUBLEST num0, den0, num1, den1;
9622 int n;
9623
9624 /* Strictly speaking, num's and den's are encoded as integer. However,
9625 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted
9626 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */
9627 n = sscanf (encoding,
9628 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT
9629 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT,
9630 &num0, &den0, &num1, &den1);
9631
9632 if (n < 2)
9633 return 1.0;
9634 else if (n == 4)
9635 return num1 / den1;
9636 else
9637 return num0 / den0;
9638 }
9639
9640
9641 /* Assuming that X is the representation of a value of fixed-point
9642 type TYPE, return its floating-point equivalent. */
9643
9644 DOUBLEST
9645 ada_fixed_to_float (struct type *type, LONGEST x)
9646 {
9647 return (DOUBLEST) x *scaling_factor (type);
9648 }
9649
9650 /* The representation of a fixed-point value of type TYPE
9651 corresponding to the value X. */
9652
9653 LONGEST
9654 ada_float_to_fixed (struct type *type, DOUBLEST x)
9655 {
9656 return (LONGEST) (x / scaling_factor (type) + 0.5);
9657 }
9658
9659
9660 /* VAX floating formats */
9661
9662 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents one of the special VAX floating-point
9663 types. */
9664
9665 int
9666 ada_is_vax_floating_type (struct type *type)
9667 {
9668 int name_len =
9669 (ada_type_name (type) == NULL) ? 0 : strlen (ada_type_name (type));
9670 return
9671 name_len > 6
9672 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
9673 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
9674 && strncmp (ada_type_name (type) + name_len - 6, "___XF", 5) == 0;
9675 }
9676
9677 /* The type of special VAX floating-point type this is, assuming
9678 ada_is_vax_floating_point. */
9679
9680 int
9681 ada_vax_float_type_suffix (struct type *type)
9682 {
9683 return ada_type_name (type)[strlen (ada_type_name (type)) - 1];
9684 }
9685
9686 /* A value representing the special debugging function that outputs
9687 VAX floating-point values of the type represented by TYPE. Assumes
9688 ada_is_vax_floating_type (TYPE). */
9689
9690 struct value *
9691 ada_vax_float_print_function (struct type *type)
9692 {
9693 switch (ada_vax_float_type_suffix (type))
9694 {
9695 case 'F':
9696 return get_var_value ("DEBUG_STRING_F", 0);
9697 case 'D':
9698 return get_var_value ("DEBUG_STRING_D", 0);
9699 case 'G':
9700 return get_var_value ("DEBUG_STRING_G", 0);
9701 default:
9702 error (_("invalid VAX floating-point type"));
9703 }
9704 }
9705 \f
9706
9707 /* Range types */
9708
9709 /* Scan STR beginning at position K for a discriminant name, and
9710 return the value of that discriminant field of DVAL in *PX. If
9711 PNEW_K is not null, put the position of the character beyond the
9712 name scanned in *PNEW_K. Return 1 if successful; return 0 and do
9713 not alter *PX and *PNEW_K if unsuccessful. */
9714
9715 static int
9716 scan_discrim_bound (char *str, int k, struct value *dval, LONGEST * px,
9717 int *pnew_k)
9718 {
9719 static char *bound_buffer = NULL;
9720 static size_t bound_buffer_len = 0;
9721 char *bound;
9722 char *pend;
9723 struct value *bound_val;
9724
9725 if (dval == NULL || str == NULL || str[k] == '\0')
9726 return 0;
9727
9728 pend = strstr (str + k, "__");
9729 if (pend == NULL)
9730 {
9731 bound = str + k;
9732 k += strlen (bound);
9733 }
9734 else
9735 {
9736 GROW_VECT (bound_buffer, bound_buffer_len, pend - (str + k) + 1);
9737 bound = bound_buffer;
9738 strncpy (bound_buffer, str + k, pend - (str + k));
9739 bound[pend - (str + k)] = '\0';
9740 k = pend - str;
9741 }
9742
9743 bound_val = ada_search_struct_field (bound, dval, 0, value_type (dval));
9744 if (bound_val == NULL)
9745 return 0;
9746
9747 *px = value_as_long (bound_val);
9748 if (pnew_k != NULL)
9749 *pnew_k = k;
9750 return 1;
9751 }
9752
9753 /* Value of variable named NAME in the current environment. If
9754 no such variable found, then if ERR_MSG is null, returns 0, and
9755 otherwise causes an error with message ERR_MSG. */
9756
9757 static struct value *
9758 get_var_value (char *name, char *err_msg)
9759 {
9760 struct ada_symbol_info *syms;
9761 int nsyms;
9762
9763 nsyms = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, get_selected_block (0), VAR_DOMAIN,
9764 &syms);
9765
9766 if (nsyms != 1)
9767 {
9768 if (err_msg == NULL)
9769 return 0;
9770 else
9771 error (("%s"), err_msg);
9772 }
9773
9774 return value_of_variable (syms[0].sym, syms[0].block);
9775 }
9776
9777 /* Value of integer variable named NAME in the current environment. If
9778 no such variable found, returns 0, and sets *FLAG to 0. If
9779 successful, sets *FLAG to 1. */
9780
9781 LONGEST
9782 get_int_var_value (char *name, int *flag)
9783 {
9784 struct value *var_val = get_var_value (name, 0);
9785
9786 if (var_val == 0)
9787 {
9788 if (flag != NULL)
9789 *flag = 0;
9790 return 0;
9791 }
9792 else
9793 {
9794 if (flag != NULL)
9795 *flag = 1;
9796 return value_as_long (var_val);
9797 }
9798 }
9799
9800
9801 /* Return a range type whose base type is that of the range type named
9802 NAME in the current environment, and whose bounds are calculated
9803 from NAME according to the GNAT range encoding conventions.
9804 Extract discriminant values, if needed, from DVAL. ORIG_TYPE is the
9805 corresponding range type from debug information; fall back to using it
9806 if symbol lookup fails. If a new type must be created, allocate it
9807 like ORIG_TYPE was. The bounds information, in general, is encoded
9808 in NAME, the base type given in the named range type. */
9809
9810 static struct type *
9811 to_fixed_range_type (char *name, struct value *dval, struct type *orig_type)
9812 {
9813 struct type *raw_type = ada_find_any_type (name);
9814 struct type *base_type;
9815 char *subtype_info;
9816
9817 /* Fall back to the original type if symbol lookup failed. */
9818 if (raw_type == NULL)
9819 raw_type = orig_type;
9820
9821 if (TYPE_CODE (raw_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
9822 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (raw_type);
9823 else
9824 base_type = raw_type;
9825
9826 subtype_info = strstr (name, "___XD");
9827 if (subtype_info == NULL)
9828 {
9829 LONGEST L = ada_discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type);
9830 LONGEST U = ada_discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type);
9831 if (L < INT_MIN || U > INT_MAX)
9832 return raw_type;
9833 else
9834 return create_range_type (alloc_type_copy (orig_type), raw_type,
9835 ada_discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type),
9836 ada_discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type));
9837 }
9838 else
9839 {
9840 static char *name_buf = NULL;
9841 static size_t name_len = 0;
9842 int prefix_len = subtype_info - name;
9843 LONGEST L, U;
9844 struct type *type;
9845 char *bounds_str;
9846 int n;
9847
9848 GROW_VECT (name_buf, name_len, prefix_len + 5);
9849 strncpy (name_buf, name, prefix_len);
9850 name_buf[prefix_len] = '\0';
9851
9852 subtype_info += 5;
9853 bounds_str = strchr (subtype_info, '_');
9854 n = 1;
9855
9856 if (*subtype_info == 'L')
9857 {
9858 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &L, &n)
9859 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &L, &n))
9860 return raw_type;
9861 if (bounds_str[n] == '_')
9862 n += 2;
9863 else if (bounds_str[n] == '.') /* FIXME? SGI Workshop kludge. */
9864 n += 1;
9865 subtype_info += 1;
9866 }
9867 else
9868 {
9869 int ok;
9870 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___L");
9871 L = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
9872 if (!ok)
9873 {
9874 lim_warning (_("Unknown lower bound, using 1."));
9875 L = 1;
9876 }
9877 }
9878
9879 if (*subtype_info == 'U')
9880 {
9881 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &U, &n)
9882 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &U, &n))
9883 return raw_type;
9884 }
9885 else
9886 {
9887 int ok;
9888 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___U");
9889 U = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
9890 if (!ok)
9891 {
9892 lim_warning (_("Unknown upper bound, using %ld."), (long) L);
9893 U = L;
9894 }
9895 }
9896
9897 type = create_range_type (alloc_type_copy (orig_type), base_type, L, U);
9898 TYPE_NAME (type) = name;
9899 return type;
9900 }
9901 }
9902
9903 /* True iff NAME is the name of a range type. */
9904
9905 int
9906 ada_is_range_type_name (const char *name)
9907 {
9908 return (name != NULL && strstr (name, "___XD"));
9909 }
9910 \f
9911
9912 /* Modular types */
9913
9914 /* True iff TYPE is an Ada modular type. */
9915
9916 int
9917 ada_is_modular_type (struct type *type)
9918 {
9919 struct type *subranged_type = base_type (type);
9920
9921 return (subranged_type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE
9922 && TYPE_CODE (subranged_type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
9923 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (subranged_type));
9924 }
9925
9926 /* Try to determine the lower and upper bounds of the given modular type
9927 using the type name only. Return non-zero and set L and U as the lower
9928 and upper bounds (respectively) if successful. */
9929
9930 int
9931 ada_modulus_from_name (struct type *type, ULONGEST *modulus)
9932 {
9933 char *name = ada_type_name (type);
9934 char *suffix;
9935 int k;
9936 LONGEST U;
9937
9938 if (name == NULL)
9939 return 0;
9940
9941 /* Discrete type bounds are encoded using an __XD suffix. In our case,
9942 we are looking for static bounds, which means an __XDLU suffix.
9943 Moreover, we know that the lower bound of modular types is always
9944 zero, so the actual suffix should start with "__XDLU_0__", and
9945 then be followed by the upper bound value. */
9946 suffix = strstr (name, "__XDLU_0__");
9947 if (suffix == NULL)
9948 return 0;
9949 k = 10;
9950 if (!ada_scan_number (suffix, k, &U, NULL))
9951 return 0;
9952
9953 *modulus = (ULONGEST) U + 1;
9954 return 1;
9955 }
9956
9957 /* Assuming ada_is_modular_type (TYPE), the modulus of TYPE. */
9958
9959 ULONGEST
9960 ada_modulus (struct type *type)
9961 {
9962 return (ULONGEST) TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type) + 1;
9963 }
9964 \f
9965
9966 /* Ada exception catchpoint support:
9967 ---------------------------------
9968
9969 We support 3 kinds of exception catchpoints:
9970 . catchpoints on Ada exceptions
9971 . catchpoints on unhandled Ada exceptions
9972 . catchpoints on failed assertions
9973
9974 Exceptions raised during failed assertions, or unhandled exceptions
9975 could perfectly be caught with the general catchpoint on Ada exceptions.
9976 However, we can easily differentiate these two special cases, and having
9977 the option to distinguish these two cases from the rest can be useful
9978 to zero-in on certain situations.
9979
9980 Exception catchpoints are a specialized form of breakpoint,
9981 since they rely on inserting breakpoints inside known routines
9982 of the GNAT runtime. The implementation therefore uses a standard
9983 breakpoint structure of the BP_BREAKPOINT type, but with its own set
9984 of breakpoint_ops.
9985
9986 Support in the runtime for exception catchpoints have been changed
9987 a few times already, and these changes affect the implementation
9988 of these catchpoints. In order to be able to support several
9989 variants of the runtime, we use a sniffer that will determine
9990 the runtime variant used by the program being debugged.
9991
9992 At this time, we do not support the use of conditions on Ada exception
9993 catchpoints. The COND and COND_STRING fields are therefore set
9994 to NULL (most of the time, see below).
9995
9996 Conditions where EXP_STRING, COND, and COND_STRING are used:
9997
9998 When a user specifies the name of a specific exception in the case
9999 of catchpoints on Ada exceptions, we store the name of that exception
10000 in the EXP_STRING. We then translate this request into an actual
10001 condition stored in COND_STRING, and then parse it into an expression
10002 stored in COND. */
10003
10004 /* The different types of catchpoints that we introduced for catching
10005 Ada exceptions. */
10006
10007 enum exception_catchpoint_kind
10008 {
10009 ex_catch_exception,
10010 ex_catch_exception_unhandled,
10011 ex_catch_assert
10012 };
10013
10014 /* Ada's standard exceptions. */
10015
10016 static char *standard_exc[] = {
10017 "constraint_error",
10018 "program_error",
10019 "storage_error",
10020 "tasking_error"
10021 };
10022
10023 typedef CORE_ADDR (ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype) (void);
10024
10025 /* A structure that describes how to support exception catchpoints
10026 for a given executable. */
10027
10028 struct exception_support_info
10029 {
10030 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
10031 a catchpoint on exceptions. */
10032 const char *catch_exception_sym;
10033
10034 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
10035 a catchpoint on unhandled exceptions. */
10036 const char *catch_exception_unhandled_sym;
10037
10038 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
10039 a catchpoint on failed assertions. */
10040 const char *catch_assert_sym;
10041
10042 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
10043 catchpoint, this function is responsible for returning the address
10044 in inferior memory where the name of that exception is stored.
10045 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
10046 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype *unhandled_exception_name_addr;
10047 };
10048
10049 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void);
10050 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void);
10051
10052 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
10053 implement exception catchpoints with the latest version of the
10054 Ada runtime (as of 2007-03-06). */
10055
10056 static const struct exception_support_info default_exception_support_info =
10057 {
10058 "__gnat_debug_raise_exception", /* catch_exception_sym */
10059 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
10060 "__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
10061 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr
10062 };
10063
10064 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
10065 implement exception catchpoints with a slightly older version
10066 of the Ada runtime. */
10067
10068 static const struct exception_support_info exception_support_info_fallback =
10069 {
10070 "__gnat_raise_nodefer_with_msg", /* catch_exception_sym */
10071 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
10072 "system__assertions__raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
10073 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise
10074 };
10075
10076 /* For each executable, we sniff which exception info structure to use
10077 and cache it in the following global variable. */
10078
10079 static const struct exception_support_info *exception_info = NULL;
10080
10081 /* Inspect the Ada runtime and determine which exception info structure
10082 should be used to provide support for exception catchpoints.
10083
10084 This function will always set exception_info, or raise an error. */
10085
10086 static void
10087 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer (void)
10088 {
10089 struct symbol *sym;
10090
10091 /* If the exception info is already known, then no need to recompute it. */
10092 if (exception_info != NULL)
10093 return;
10094
10095 /* Check the latest (default) exception support info. */
10096 sym = standard_lookup (default_exception_support_info.catch_exception_sym,
10097 NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
10098 if (sym != NULL)
10099 {
10100 exception_info = &default_exception_support_info;
10101 return;
10102 }
10103
10104 /* Try our fallback exception suport info. */
10105 sym = standard_lookup (exception_support_info_fallback.catch_exception_sym,
10106 NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
10107 if (sym != NULL)
10108 {
10109 exception_info = &exception_support_info_fallback;
10110 return;
10111 }
10112
10113 /* Sometimes, it is normal for us to not be able to find the routine
10114 we are looking for. This happens when the program is linked with
10115 the shared version of the GNAT runtime, and the program has not been
10116 started yet. Inform the user of these two possible causes if
10117 applicable. */
10118
10119 if (ada_update_initial_language (language_unknown, NULL) != language_ada)
10120 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Is this an Ada main program?"));
10121
10122 /* If the symbol does not exist, then check that the program is
10123 already started, to make sure that shared libraries have been
10124 loaded. If it is not started, this may mean that the symbol is
10125 in a shared library. */
10126
10127 if (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid) == 0)
10128 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Try to start the program first."));
10129
10130 /* At this point, we know that we are debugging an Ada program and
10131 that the inferior has been started, but we still are not able to
10132 find the run-time symbols. That can mean that we are in
10133 configurable run time mode, or that a-except as been optimized
10134 out by the linker... In any case, at this point it is not worth
10135 supporting this feature. */
10136
10137 error (_("Cannot insert catchpoints in this configuration."));
10138 }
10139
10140 /* An observer of "executable_changed" events.
10141 Its role is to clear certain cached values that need to be recomputed
10142 each time a new executable is loaded by GDB. */
10143
10144 static void
10145 ada_executable_changed_observer (void)
10146 {
10147 /* If the executable changed, then it is possible that the Ada runtime
10148 is different. So we need to invalidate the exception support info
10149 cache. */
10150 exception_info = NULL;
10151 }
10152
10153 /* Return the name of the function at PC, NULL if could not find it.
10154 This function only checks the debugging information, not the symbol
10155 table. */
10156
10157 static char *
10158 function_name_from_pc (CORE_ADDR pc)
10159 {
10160 char *func_name;
10161
10162 if (!find_pc_partial_function (pc, &func_name, NULL, NULL))
10163 return NULL;
10164
10165 return func_name;
10166 }
10167
10168 /* True iff FRAME is very likely to be that of a function that is
10169 part of the runtime system. This is all very heuristic, but is
10170 intended to be used as advice as to what frames are uninteresting
10171 to most users. */
10172
10173 static int
10174 is_known_support_routine (struct frame_info *frame)
10175 {
10176 struct symtab_and_line sal;
10177 char *func_name;
10178 int i;
10179
10180 /* If this code does not have any debugging information (no symtab),
10181 This cannot be any user code. */
10182
10183 find_frame_sal (frame, &sal);
10184 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
10185 return 1;
10186
10187 /* If there is a symtab, but the associated source file cannot be
10188 located, then assume this is not user code: Selecting a frame
10189 for which we cannot display the code would not be very helpful
10190 for the user. This should also take care of case such as VxWorks
10191 where the kernel has some debugging info provided for a few units. */
10192
10193 if (symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab) == NULL)
10194 return 1;
10195
10196 /* Check the unit filename againt the Ada runtime file naming.
10197 We also check the name of the objfile against the name of some
10198 known system libraries that sometimes come with debugging info
10199 too. */
10200
10201 for (i = 0; known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
10202 {
10203 re_comp (known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i]);
10204 if (re_exec (sal.symtab->filename))
10205 return 1;
10206 if (sal.symtab->objfile != NULL
10207 && re_exec (sal.symtab->objfile->name))
10208 return 1;
10209 }
10210
10211 /* Check whether the function is a GNAT-generated entity. */
10212
10213 func_name = function_name_from_pc (get_frame_address_in_block (frame));
10214 if (func_name == NULL)
10215 return 1;
10216
10217 for (i = 0; known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
10218 {
10219 re_comp (known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i]);
10220 if (re_exec (func_name))
10221 return 1;
10222 }
10223
10224 return 0;
10225 }
10226
10227 /* Find the first frame that contains debugging information and that is not
10228 part of the Ada run-time, starting from FI and moving upward. */
10229
10230 void
10231 ada_find_printable_frame (struct frame_info *fi)
10232 {
10233 for (; fi != NULL; fi = get_prev_frame (fi))
10234 {
10235 if (!is_known_support_routine (fi))
10236 {
10237 select_frame (fi);
10238 break;
10239 }
10240 }
10241
10242 }
10243
10244 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
10245 catchpoint, return the address in inferior memory where the name
10246 of the exception is stored.
10247
10248 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
10249
10250 static CORE_ADDR
10251 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void)
10252 {
10253 return parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name");
10254 }
10255
10256 /* Same as ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr, except that this function
10257 should be used when the inferior uses an older version of the runtime,
10258 where the exception name needs to be extracted from a specific frame
10259 several frames up in the callstack. */
10260
10261 static CORE_ADDR
10262 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void)
10263 {
10264 int frame_level;
10265 struct frame_info *fi;
10266
10267 /* To determine the name of this exception, we need to select
10268 the frame corresponding to RAISE_SYM_NAME. This frame is
10269 at least 3 levels up, so we simply skip the first 3 frames
10270 without checking the name of their associated function. */
10271 fi = get_current_frame ();
10272 for (frame_level = 0; frame_level < 3; frame_level += 1)
10273 if (fi != NULL)
10274 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
10275
10276 while (fi != NULL)
10277 {
10278 const char *func_name =
10279 function_name_from_pc (get_frame_address_in_block (fi));
10280 if (func_name != NULL
10281 && strcmp (func_name, exception_info->catch_exception_sym) == 0)
10282 break; /* We found the frame we were looking for... */
10283 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
10284 }
10285
10286 if (fi == NULL)
10287 return 0;
10288
10289 select_frame (fi);
10290 return parse_and_eval_address ("id.full_name");
10291 }
10292
10293 /* Assuming the inferior just triggered an Ada exception catchpoint
10294 (of any type), return the address in inferior memory where the name
10295 of the exception is stored, if applicable.
10296
10297 Return zero if the address could not be computed, or if not relevant. */
10298
10299 static CORE_ADDR
10300 ada_exception_name_addr_1 (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10301 struct breakpoint *b)
10302 {
10303 switch (ex)
10304 {
10305 case ex_catch_exception:
10306 return (parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name"));
10307 break;
10308
10309 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10310 return exception_info->unhandled_exception_name_addr ();
10311 break;
10312
10313 case ex_catch_assert:
10314 return 0; /* Exception name is not relevant in this case. */
10315 break;
10316
10317 default:
10318 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
10319 break;
10320 }
10321
10322 return 0; /* Should never be reached. */
10323 }
10324
10325 /* Same as ada_exception_name_addr_1, except that it intercepts and contains
10326 any error that ada_exception_name_addr_1 might cause to be thrown.
10327 When an error is intercepted, a warning with the error message is printed,
10328 and zero is returned. */
10329
10330 static CORE_ADDR
10331 ada_exception_name_addr (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10332 struct breakpoint *b)
10333 {
10334 struct gdb_exception e;
10335 CORE_ADDR result = 0;
10336
10337 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
10338 {
10339 result = ada_exception_name_addr_1 (ex, b);
10340 }
10341
10342 if (e.reason < 0)
10343 {
10344 warning (_("failed to get exception name: %s"), e.message);
10345 return 0;
10346 }
10347
10348 return result;
10349 }
10350
10351 /* Implement the PRINT_IT method in the breakpoint_ops structure
10352 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
10353
10354 static enum print_stop_action
10355 print_it_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, struct breakpoint *b)
10356 {
10357 const CORE_ADDR addr = ada_exception_name_addr (ex, b);
10358 char exception_name[256];
10359
10360 if (addr != 0)
10361 {
10362 read_memory (addr, exception_name, sizeof (exception_name) - 1);
10363 exception_name [sizeof (exception_name) - 1] = '\0';
10364 }
10365
10366 ada_find_printable_frame (get_current_frame ());
10367
10368 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
10369 switch (ex)
10370 {
10371 case ex_catch_exception:
10372 if (addr != 0)
10373 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, %s at "),
10374 b->number, exception_name);
10375 else
10376 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, exception at "), b->number);
10377 break;
10378 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10379 if (addr != 0)
10380 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, unhandled %s at "),
10381 b->number, exception_name);
10382 else
10383 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, unhandled exception at "),
10384 b->number);
10385 break;
10386 case ex_catch_assert:
10387 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, failed assertion at "),
10388 b->number);
10389 break;
10390 }
10391
10392 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
10393 }
10394
10395 /* Implement the PRINT_ONE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
10396 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
10397
10398 static void
10399 print_one_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10400 struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
10401 {
10402 struct value_print_options opts;
10403
10404 get_user_print_options (&opts);
10405 if (opts.addressprint)
10406 {
10407 annotate_field (4);
10408 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr", b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
10409 }
10410
10411 annotate_field (5);
10412 *last_loc = b->loc;
10413 switch (ex)
10414 {
10415 case ex_catch_exception:
10416 if (b->exp_string != NULL)
10417 {
10418 char *msg = xstrprintf (_("`%s' Ada exception"), b->exp_string);
10419
10420 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", msg);
10421 xfree (msg);
10422 }
10423 else
10424 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "all Ada exceptions");
10425
10426 break;
10427
10428 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10429 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "unhandled Ada exceptions");
10430 break;
10431
10432 case ex_catch_assert:
10433 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "failed Ada assertions");
10434 break;
10435
10436 default:
10437 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
10438 break;
10439 }
10440 }
10441
10442 /* Implement the PRINT_MENTION method in the breakpoint_ops structure
10443 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
10444
10445 static void
10446 print_mention_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10447 struct breakpoint *b)
10448 {
10449 switch (ex)
10450 {
10451 case ex_catch_exception:
10452 if (b->exp_string != NULL)
10453 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: `%s' Ada exception"),
10454 b->number, b->exp_string);
10455 else
10456 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: all Ada exceptions"), b->number);
10457
10458 break;
10459
10460 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10461 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: unhandled Ada exceptions"),
10462 b->number);
10463 break;
10464
10465 case ex_catch_assert:
10466 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: failed Ada assertions"), b->number);
10467 break;
10468
10469 default:
10470 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
10471 break;
10472 }
10473 }
10474
10475 /* Virtual table for "catch exception" breakpoints. */
10476
10477 static enum print_stop_action
10478 print_it_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
10479 {
10480 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_exception, b);
10481 }
10482
10483 static void
10484 print_one_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
10485 {
10486 print_one_exception (ex_catch_exception, b, last_loc);
10487 }
10488
10489 static void
10490 print_mention_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
10491 {
10492 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_exception, b);
10493 }
10494
10495 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_breakpoint_ops =
10496 {
10497 NULL, /* insert */
10498 NULL, /* remove */
10499 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
10500 print_it_catch_exception,
10501 print_one_catch_exception,
10502 print_mention_catch_exception
10503 };
10504
10505 /* Virtual table for "catch exception unhandled" breakpoints. */
10506
10507 static enum print_stop_action
10508 print_it_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
10509 {
10510 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
10511 }
10512
10513 static void
10514 print_one_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b,
10515 struct bp_location **last_loc)
10516 {
10517 print_one_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b, last_loc);
10518 }
10519
10520 static void
10521 print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
10522 {
10523 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
10524 }
10525
10526 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops = {
10527 NULL, /* insert */
10528 NULL, /* remove */
10529 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
10530 print_it_catch_exception_unhandled,
10531 print_one_catch_exception_unhandled,
10532 print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled
10533 };
10534
10535 /* Virtual table for "catch assert" breakpoints. */
10536
10537 static enum print_stop_action
10538 print_it_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
10539 {
10540 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_assert, b);
10541 }
10542
10543 static void
10544 print_one_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
10545 {
10546 print_one_exception (ex_catch_assert, b, last_loc);
10547 }
10548
10549 static void
10550 print_mention_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
10551 {
10552 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_assert, b);
10553 }
10554
10555 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_assert_breakpoint_ops = {
10556 NULL, /* insert */
10557 NULL, /* remove */
10558 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
10559 print_it_catch_assert,
10560 print_one_catch_assert,
10561 print_mention_catch_assert
10562 };
10563
10564 /* Return non-zero if B is an Ada exception catchpoint. */
10565
10566 int
10567 ada_exception_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
10568 {
10569 return (b->ops == &catch_exception_breakpoint_ops
10570 || b->ops == &catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops
10571 || b->ops == &catch_assert_breakpoint_ops);
10572 }
10573
10574 /* Return a newly allocated copy of the first space-separated token
10575 in ARGSP, and then adjust ARGSP to point immediately after that
10576 token.
10577
10578 Return NULL if ARGPS does not contain any more tokens. */
10579
10580 static char *
10581 ada_get_next_arg (char **argsp)
10582 {
10583 char *args = *argsp;
10584 char *end;
10585 char *result;
10586
10587 /* Skip any leading white space. */
10588
10589 while (isspace (*args))
10590 args++;
10591
10592 if (args[0] == '\0')
10593 return NULL; /* No more arguments. */
10594
10595 /* Find the end of the current argument. */
10596
10597 end = args;
10598 while (*end != '\0' && !isspace (*end))
10599 end++;
10600
10601 /* Adjust ARGSP to point to the start of the next argument. */
10602
10603 *argsp = end;
10604
10605 /* Make a copy of the current argument and return it. */
10606
10607 result = xmalloc (end - args + 1);
10608 strncpy (result, args, end - args);
10609 result[end - args] = '\0';
10610
10611 return result;
10612 }
10613
10614 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch exception" command.
10615 Set EX to the appropriate catchpoint type.
10616 Set EXP_STRING to the name of the specific exception if
10617 specified by the user. */
10618
10619 static void
10620 catch_ada_exception_command_split (char *args,
10621 enum exception_catchpoint_kind *ex,
10622 char **exp_string)
10623 {
10624 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
10625 char *exception_name;
10626
10627 exception_name = ada_get_next_arg (&args);
10628 make_cleanup (xfree, exception_name);
10629
10630 /* Check that we do not have any more arguments. Anything else
10631 is unexpected. */
10632
10633 while (isspace (*args))
10634 args++;
10635
10636 if (args[0] != '\0')
10637 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
10638
10639 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
10640
10641 if (exception_name == NULL)
10642 {
10643 /* Catch all exceptions. */
10644 *ex = ex_catch_exception;
10645 *exp_string = NULL;
10646 }
10647 else if (strcmp (exception_name, "unhandled") == 0)
10648 {
10649 /* Catch unhandled exceptions. */
10650 *ex = ex_catch_exception_unhandled;
10651 *exp_string = NULL;
10652 }
10653 else
10654 {
10655 /* Catch a specific exception. */
10656 *ex = ex_catch_exception;
10657 *exp_string = exception_name;
10658 }
10659 }
10660
10661 /* Return the name of the symbol on which we should break in order to
10662 implement a catchpoint of the EX kind. */
10663
10664 static const char *
10665 ada_exception_sym_name (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
10666 {
10667 gdb_assert (exception_info != NULL);
10668
10669 switch (ex)
10670 {
10671 case ex_catch_exception:
10672 return (exception_info->catch_exception_sym);
10673 break;
10674 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10675 return (exception_info->catch_exception_unhandled_sym);
10676 break;
10677 case ex_catch_assert:
10678 return (exception_info->catch_assert_sym);
10679 break;
10680 default:
10681 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10682 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
10683 }
10684 }
10685
10686 /* Return the breakpoint ops "virtual table" used for catchpoints
10687 of the EX kind. */
10688
10689 static struct breakpoint_ops *
10690 ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
10691 {
10692 switch (ex)
10693 {
10694 case ex_catch_exception:
10695 return (&catch_exception_breakpoint_ops);
10696 break;
10697 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10698 return (&catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops);
10699 break;
10700 case ex_catch_assert:
10701 return (&catch_assert_breakpoint_ops);
10702 break;
10703 default:
10704 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10705 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
10706 }
10707 }
10708
10709 /* Return the condition that will be used to match the current exception
10710 being raised with the exception that the user wants to catch. This
10711 assumes that this condition is used when the inferior just triggered
10712 an exception catchpoint.
10713
10714 The string returned is a newly allocated string that needs to be
10715 deallocated later. */
10716
10717 static char *
10718 ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *exp_string)
10719 {
10720 int i;
10721
10722 /* The standard exceptions are a special case. They are defined in
10723 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info; if
10724 EXP_STRING is the not-fully-qualified name of a standard
10725 exception (e.g. "constraint_error") then, during the evaluation
10726 of the condition expression, the symbol lookup on this name would
10727 *not* return this standard exception. The catchpoint condition
10728 may then be set only on user-defined exceptions which have the
10729 same not-fully-qualified name (e.g. my_package.constraint_error).
10730
10731 To avoid this unexcepted behavior, these standard exceptions are
10732 systematically prefixed by "standard". This means that "catch
10733 exception constraint_error" is rewritten into "catch exception
10734 standard.constraint_error".
10735
10736 If an exception named contraint_error is defined in another package of
10737 the inferior program, then the only way to specify this exception as a
10738 breakpoint condition is to use its fully-qualified named:
10739 e.g. my_package.constraint_error. */
10740
10741 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (standard_exc) / sizeof (char *); i++)
10742 {
10743 if (strcmp (standard_exc [i], exp_string) == 0)
10744 {
10745 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&standard.%s)",
10746 exp_string);
10747 }
10748 }
10749 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&%s)", exp_string);
10750 }
10751
10752 /* Return the expression corresponding to COND_STRING evaluated at SAL. */
10753
10754 static struct expression *
10755 ada_parse_catchpoint_condition (char *cond_string,
10756 struct symtab_and_line sal)
10757 {
10758 return (parse_exp_1 (&cond_string, block_for_pc (sal.pc), 0));
10759 }
10760
10761 /* Return the symtab_and_line that should be used to insert an exception
10762 catchpoint of the TYPE kind.
10763
10764 EX_STRING should contain the name of a specific exception
10765 that the catchpoint should catch, or NULL otherwise.
10766
10767 The idea behind all the remaining parameters is that their names match
10768 the name of certain fields in the breakpoint structure that are used to
10769 handle exception catchpoints. This function returns the value to which
10770 these fields should be set, depending on the type of catchpoint we need
10771 to create.
10772
10773 If COND and COND_STRING are both non-NULL, any value they might
10774 hold will be free'ed, and then replaced by newly allocated ones.
10775 These parameters are left untouched otherwise. */
10776
10777 static struct symtab_and_line
10778 ada_exception_sal (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, char *exp_string,
10779 char **addr_string, char **cond_string,
10780 struct expression **cond, struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
10781 {
10782 const char *sym_name;
10783 struct symbol *sym;
10784 struct symtab_and_line sal;
10785
10786 /* First, find out which exception support info to use. */
10787 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer ();
10788
10789 /* Then lookup the function on which we will break in order to catch
10790 the Ada exceptions requested by the user. */
10791
10792 sym_name = ada_exception_sym_name (ex);
10793 sym = standard_lookup (sym_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
10794
10795 /* The symbol we're looking up is provided by a unit in the GNAT runtime
10796 that should be compiled with debugging information. As a result, we
10797 expect to find that symbol in the symtabs. If we don't find it, then
10798 the target most likely does not support Ada exceptions, or we cannot
10799 insert exception breakpoints yet, because the GNAT runtime hasn't been
10800 loaded yet. */
10801
10802 /* brobecker/2006-12-26: It is conceivable that the runtime was compiled
10803 in such a way that no debugging information is produced for the symbol
10804 we are looking for. In this case, we could search the minimal symbols
10805 as a fall-back mechanism. This would still be operating in degraded
10806 mode, however, as we would still be missing the debugging information
10807 that is needed in order to extract the name of the exception being
10808 raised (this name is printed in the catchpoint message, and is also
10809 used when trying to catch a specific exception). We do not handle
10810 this case for now. */
10811
10812 if (sym == NULL)
10813 error (_("Unable to break on '%s' in this configuration."), sym_name);
10814
10815 /* Make sure that the symbol we found corresponds to a function. */
10816 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
10817 error (_("Symbol \"%s\" is not a function (class = %d)"),
10818 sym_name, SYMBOL_CLASS (sym));
10819
10820 sal = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
10821
10822 /* Set ADDR_STRING. */
10823
10824 *addr_string = xstrdup (sym_name);
10825
10826 /* Set the COND and COND_STRING (if not NULL). */
10827
10828 if (cond_string != NULL && cond != NULL)
10829 {
10830 if (*cond_string != NULL)
10831 {
10832 xfree (*cond_string);
10833 *cond_string = NULL;
10834 }
10835 if (*cond != NULL)
10836 {
10837 xfree (*cond);
10838 *cond = NULL;
10839 }
10840 if (exp_string != NULL)
10841 {
10842 *cond_string = ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (exp_string);
10843 *cond = ada_parse_catchpoint_condition (*cond_string, sal);
10844 }
10845 }
10846
10847 /* Set OPS. */
10848 *ops = ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (ex);
10849
10850 return sal;
10851 }
10852
10853 /* Parse the arguments (ARGS) of the "catch exception" command.
10854
10855 Set TYPE to the appropriate exception catchpoint type.
10856 If the user asked the catchpoint to catch only a specific
10857 exception, then save the exception name in ADDR_STRING.
10858
10859 See ada_exception_sal for a description of all the remaining
10860 function arguments of this function. */
10861
10862 struct symtab_and_line
10863 ada_decode_exception_location (char *args, char **addr_string,
10864 char **exp_string, char **cond_string,
10865 struct expression **cond,
10866 struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
10867 {
10868 enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex;
10869
10870 catch_ada_exception_command_split (args, &ex, exp_string);
10871 return ada_exception_sal (ex, *exp_string, addr_string, cond_string,
10872 cond, ops);
10873 }
10874
10875 struct symtab_and_line
10876 ada_decode_assert_location (char *args, char **addr_string,
10877 struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
10878 {
10879 /* Check that no argument where provided at the end of the command. */
10880
10881 if (args != NULL)
10882 {
10883 while (isspace (*args))
10884 args++;
10885 if (*args != '\0')
10886 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
10887 }
10888
10889 return ada_exception_sal (ex_catch_assert, NULL, addr_string, NULL, NULL,
10890 ops);
10891 }
10892
10893 /* Operators */
10894 /* Information about operators given special treatment in functions
10895 below. */
10896 /* Format: OP_DEFN (<operator>, <operator length>, <# args>, <binop>). */
10897
10898 #define ADA_OPERATORS \
10899 OP_DEFN (OP_VAR_VALUE, 4, 0, 0) \
10900 OP_DEFN (BINOP_IN_BOUNDS, 3, 2, 0) \
10901 OP_DEFN (TERNOP_IN_RANGE, 1, 3, 0) \
10902 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_FIRST, 1, 2, 0) \
10903 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LAST, 1, 2, 0) \
10904 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LENGTH, 1, 2, 0) \
10905 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_IMAGE, 1, 2, 0) \
10906 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MAX, 1, 3, 0) \
10907 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MIN, 1, 3, 0) \
10908 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MODULUS, 1, 1, 0) \
10909 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_POS, 1, 2, 0) \
10910 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_SIZE, 1, 1, 0) \
10911 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_TAG, 1, 1, 0) \
10912 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_VAL, 1, 2, 0) \
10913 OP_DEFN (UNOP_QUAL, 3, 1, 0) \
10914 OP_DEFN (UNOP_IN_RANGE, 3, 1, 0) \
10915 OP_DEFN (OP_OTHERS, 1, 1, 0) \
10916 OP_DEFN (OP_POSITIONAL, 3, 1, 0) \
10917 OP_DEFN (OP_DISCRETE_RANGE, 1, 2, 0)
10918
10919 static void
10920 ada_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc, int *oplenp, int *argsp)
10921 {
10922 switch (exp->elts[pc - 1].opcode)
10923 {
10924 default:
10925 operator_length_standard (exp, pc, oplenp, argsp);
10926 break;
10927
10928 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
10929 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
10930 ADA_OPERATORS;
10931 #undef OP_DEFN
10932
10933 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10934 *oplenp = 3;
10935 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst);
10936 break;
10937
10938 case OP_CHOICES:
10939 *oplenp = 3;
10940 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst) + 1;
10941 break;
10942 }
10943 }
10944
10945 static char *
10946 ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode opcode)
10947 {
10948 switch (opcode)
10949 {
10950 default:
10951 return op_name_standard (opcode);
10952
10953 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) case op: return #op;
10954 ADA_OPERATORS;
10955 #undef OP_DEFN
10956
10957 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10958 return "OP_AGGREGATE";
10959 case OP_CHOICES:
10960 return "OP_CHOICES";
10961 case OP_NAME:
10962 return "OP_NAME";
10963 }
10964 }
10965
10966 /* As for operator_length, but assumes PC is pointing at the first
10967 element of the operator, and gives meaningful results only for the
10968 Ada-specific operators, returning 0 for *OPLENP and *ARGSP otherwise. */
10969
10970 static void
10971 ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc,
10972 int *oplenp, int *argsp)
10973 {
10974 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
10975 {
10976 default:
10977 *oplenp = *argsp = 0;
10978 break;
10979
10980 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
10981 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
10982 ADA_OPERATORS;
10983 #undef OP_DEFN
10984
10985 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10986 *oplenp = 3;
10987 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10988 break;
10989
10990 case OP_CHOICES:
10991 *oplenp = 3;
10992 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst) + 1;
10993 break;
10994
10995 case OP_STRING:
10996 case OP_NAME:
10997 {
10998 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10999 *oplenp = 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (len + 1);
11000 *argsp = 0;
11001 break;
11002 }
11003 }
11004 }
11005
11006 static int
11007 ada_dump_subexp_body (struct expression *exp, struct ui_file *stream, int elt)
11008 {
11009 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[elt].opcode;
11010 int oplen, nargs;
11011 int pc = elt;
11012 int i;
11013
11014 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, elt, &oplen, &nargs);
11015
11016 switch (op)
11017 {
11018 /* Ada attributes ('Foo). */
11019 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
11020 case OP_ATR_LAST:
11021 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
11022 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
11023 case OP_ATR_MAX:
11024 case OP_ATR_MIN:
11025 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
11026 case OP_ATR_POS:
11027 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
11028 case OP_ATR_TAG:
11029 case OP_ATR_VAL:
11030 break;
11031
11032 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
11033 case UNOP_QUAL:
11034 /* XXX: gdb_sprint_host_address, type_sprint */
11035 fprintf_filtered (stream, _("Type @"));
11036 gdb_print_host_address (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, stream);
11037 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (");
11038 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, NULL, stream, 0);
11039 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")");
11040 break;
11041 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
11042 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (%d)",
11043 longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 2].longconst));
11044 break;
11045 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
11046 break;
11047
11048 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11049 case OP_OTHERS:
11050 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
11051 case OP_POSITIONAL:
11052 case OP_CHOICES:
11053 break;
11054
11055 case OP_NAME:
11056 case OP_STRING:
11057 {
11058 char *name = &exp->elts[elt + 2].string;
11059 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[elt + 1].longconst);
11060 fprintf_filtered (stream, "Text: `%.*s'", len, name);
11061 break;
11062 }
11063
11064 default:
11065 return dump_subexp_body_standard (exp, stream, elt);
11066 }
11067
11068 elt += oplen;
11069 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
11070 elt = dump_subexp (exp, stream, elt);
11071
11072 return elt;
11073 }
11074
11075 /* The Ada extension of print_subexp (q.v.). */
11076
11077 static void
11078 ada_print_subexp (struct expression *exp, int *pos,
11079 struct ui_file *stream, enum precedence prec)
11080 {
11081 int oplen, nargs, i;
11082 int pc = *pos;
11083 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
11084
11085 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
11086
11087 *pos += oplen;
11088 switch (op)
11089 {
11090 default:
11091 *pos -= oplen;
11092 print_subexp_standard (exp, pos, stream, prec);
11093 return;
11094
11095 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
11096 fputs_filtered (SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol), stream);
11097 return;
11098
11099 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
11100 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
11101 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11102 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
11103 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11104 fputs_filtered ("'range", stream);
11105 if (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst > 1)
11106 fprintf_filtered (stream, "(%ld)",
11107 (long) exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
11108 return;
11109
11110 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
11111 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
11112 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
11113 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
11114 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11115 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
11116 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
11117 fputs_filtered (" .. ", stream);
11118 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
11119 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
11120 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
11121 return;
11122
11123 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
11124 case OP_ATR_LAST:
11125 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
11126 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
11127 case OP_ATR_MAX:
11128 case OP_ATR_MIN:
11129 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
11130 case OP_ATR_POS:
11131 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
11132 case OP_ATR_TAG:
11133 case OP_ATR_VAL:
11134 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
11135 {
11136 if (TYPE_CODE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID)
11137 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type, "", stream, 0, 0);
11138 *pos += 3;
11139 }
11140 else
11141 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11142 fprintf_filtered (stream, "'%s", ada_attribute_name (op));
11143 if (nargs > 1)
11144 {
11145 int tem;
11146 for (tem = 1; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
11147 {
11148 fputs_filtered ((tem == 1) ? " (" : ", ", stream);
11149 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_ABOVE_COMMA);
11150 }
11151 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
11152 }
11153 return;
11154
11155 case UNOP_QUAL:
11156 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 0);
11157 fputs_filtered ("'(", stream);
11158 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_PREFIX);
11159 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
11160 return;
11161
11162 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
11163 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
11164 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11165 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
11166 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 1, 0);
11167 return;
11168
11169 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
11170 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11171 fputs_filtered ("..", stream);
11172 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11173 return;
11174
11175 case OP_OTHERS:
11176 fputs_filtered ("others => ", stream);
11177 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11178 return;
11179
11180 case OP_CHOICES:
11181 for (i = 0; i < nargs-1; i += 1)
11182 {
11183 if (i > 0)
11184 fputs_filtered ("|", stream);
11185 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11186 }
11187 fputs_filtered (" => ", stream);
11188 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11189 return;
11190
11191 case OP_POSITIONAL:
11192 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11193 return;
11194
11195 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11196 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
11197 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
11198 {
11199 if (i > 0)
11200 fputs_filtered (", ", stream);
11201 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11202 }
11203 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
11204 return;
11205 }
11206 }
11207
11208 /* Table mapping opcodes into strings for printing operators
11209 and precedences of the operators. */
11210
11211 static const struct op_print ada_op_print_tab[] = {
11212 {":=", BINOP_ASSIGN, PREC_ASSIGN, 1},
11213 {"or else", BINOP_LOGICAL_OR, PREC_LOGICAL_OR, 0},
11214 {"and then", BINOP_LOGICAL_AND, PREC_LOGICAL_AND, 0},
11215 {"or", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR, PREC_BITWISE_IOR, 0},
11216 {"xor", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR, PREC_BITWISE_XOR, 0},
11217 {"and", BINOP_BITWISE_AND, PREC_BITWISE_AND, 0},
11218 {"=", BINOP_EQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
11219 {"/=", BINOP_NOTEQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
11220 {"<=", BINOP_LEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
11221 {">=", BINOP_GEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
11222 {">", BINOP_GTR, PREC_ORDER, 0},
11223 {"<", BINOP_LESS, PREC_ORDER, 0},
11224 {">>", BINOP_RSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
11225 {"<<", BINOP_LSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
11226 {"+", BINOP_ADD, PREC_ADD, 0},
11227 {"-", BINOP_SUB, PREC_ADD, 0},
11228 {"&", BINOP_CONCAT, PREC_ADD, 0},
11229 {"*", BINOP_MUL, PREC_MUL, 0},
11230 {"/", BINOP_DIV, PREC_MUL, 0},
11231 {"rem", BINOP_REM, PREC_MUL, 0},
11232 {"mod", BINOP_MOD, PREC_MUL, 0},
11233 {"**", BINOP_EXP, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
11234 {"@", BINOP_REPEAT, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
11235 {"-", UNOP_NEG, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
11236 {"+", UNOP_PLUS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
11237 {"not ", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
11238 {"not ", UNOP_COMPLEMENT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
11239 {"abs ", UNOP_ABS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
11240 {".all", UNOP_IND, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
11241 {"'access", UNOP_ADDR, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
11242 {"'size", OP_ATR_SIZE, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
11243 {NULL, 0, 0, 0}
11244 };
11245 \f
11246 enum ada_primitive_types {
11247 ada_primitive_type_int,
11248 ada_primitive_type_long,
11249 ada_primitive_type_short,
11250 ada_primitive_type_char,
11251 ada_primitive_type_float,
11252 ada_primitive_type_double,
11253 ada_primitive_type_void,
11254 ada_primitive_type_long_long,
11255 ada_primitive_type_long_double,
11256 ada_primitive_type_natural,
11257 ada_primitive_type_positive,
11258 ada_primitive_type_system_address,
11259 nr_ada_primitive_types
11260 };
11261
11262 static void
11263 ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11264 struct language_arch_info *lai)
11265 {
11266 const struct builtin_type *builtin = builtin_type (gdbarch);
11267 lai->primitive_type_vector
11268 = GDBARCH_OBSTACK_CALLOC (gdbarch, nr_ada_primitive_types + 1,
11269 struct type *);
11270
11271 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_int]
11272 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
11273 0, "integer");
11274 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long]
11275 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_bit (gdbarch),
11276 0, "long_integer");
11277 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_short]
11278 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_short_bit (gdbarch),
11279 0, "short_integer");
11280 lai->string_char_type
11281 = lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_char]
11282 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, TARGET_CHAR_BIT, 0, "character");
11283 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_float]
11284 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_float_bit (gdbarch),
11285 "float", NULL);
11286 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_double]
11287 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch),
11288 "long_float", NULL);
11289 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_long]
11290 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_long_bit (gdbarch),
11291 0, "long_long_integer");
11292 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_double]
11293 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch),
11294 "long_long_float", NULL);
11295 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_natural]
11296 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
11297 0, "natural");
11298 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_positive]
11299 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
11300 0, "positive");
11301 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_void]
11302 = builtin->builtin_void;
11303
11304 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address]
11305 = lookup_pointer_type (arch_type (gdbarch, TYPE_CODE_VOID, 1, "void"));
11306 TYPE_NAME (lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address])
11307 = "system__address";
11308
11309 lai->bool_type_symbol = NULL;
11310 lai->bool_type_default = builtin->builtin_bool;
11311 }
11312 \f
11313 /* Language vector */
11314
11315 /* Not really used, but needed in the ada_language_defn. */
11316
11317 static void
11318 emit_char (int c, struct type *type, struct ui_file *stream, int quoter)
11319 {
11320 ada_emit_char (c, type, stream, quoter, 1);
11321 }
11322
11323 static int
11324 parse (void)
11325 {
11326 warnings_issued = 0;
11327 return ada_parse ();
11328 }
11329
11330 static const struct exp_descriptor ada_exp_descriptor = {
11331 ada_print_subexp,
11332 ada_operator_length,
11333 ada_op_name,
11334 ada_dump_subexp_body,
11335 ada_evaluate_subexp
11336 };
11337
11338 const struct language_defn ada_language_defn = {
11339 "ada", /* Language name */
11340 language_ada,
11341 range_check_off,
11342 type_check_off,
11343 case_sensitive_on, /* Yes, Ada is case-insensitive, but
11344 that's not quite what this means. */
11345 array_row_major,
11346 macro_expansion_no,
11347 &ada_exp_descriptor,
11348 parse,
11349 ada_error,
11350 resolve,
11351 ada_printchar, /* Print a character constant */
11352 ada_printstr, /* Function to print string constant */
11353 emit_char, /* Function to print single char (not used) */
11354 ada_print_type, /* Print a type using appropriate syntax */
11355 default_print_typedef, /* Print a typedef using appropriate syntax */
11356 ada_val_print, /* Print a value using appropriate syntax */
11357 ada_value_print, /* Print a top-level value */
11358 NULL, /* Language specific skip_trampoline */
11359 NULL, /* name_of_this */
11360 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal, /* Looking up non-local symbols. */
11361 basic_lookup_transparent_type, /* lookup_transparent_type */
11362 ada_la_decode, /* Language specific symbol demangler */
11363 NULL, /* Language specific class_name_from_physname */
11364 ada_op_print_tab, /* expression operators for printing */
11365 0, /* c-style arrays */
11366 1, /* String lower bound */
11367 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters,
11368 ada_make_symbol_completion_list,
11369 ada_language_arch_info,
11370 ada_print_array_index,
11371 default_pass_by_reference,
11372 c_get_string,
11373 LANG_MAGIC
11374 };
11375
11376 /* Provide a prototype to silence -Wmissing-prototypes. */
11377 extern initialize_file_ftype _initialize_ada_language;
11378
11379 void
11380 _initialize_ada_language (void)
11381 {
11382 add_language (&ada_language_defn);
11383
11384 varsize_limit = 65536;
11385
11386 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
11387
11388 decoded_names_store = htab_create_alloc
11389 (256, htab_hash_string, (int (*)(const void *, const void *)) streq,
11390 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
11391
11392 observer_attach_executable_changed (ada_executable_changed_observer);
11393 }
This page took 0.296493 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.